61d3987383888836dcab585d8ac824a335edd198
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @deffn {Command} {find} 'filename'
1363 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules.
1364 @end deffn
1365
1366 @deffn {Command} {ocd_find} 'filename'
1367 Prints full path to @var{filename} according to OpenOCD search rules. This
1368 is a low level function used by the @command{find}. Usually you want
1369 to use @command{find}, instead.
1370 @end deffn
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter speed 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter speed 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1810 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1811 following example.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 @example
1815 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1816 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1817 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1818 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1820 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1821 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > resume
1824 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1826 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1829 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1830 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1831 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 @end example
1833
1834
1835 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1836
1837 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1838 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1839 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1840
1841 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1842 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1843 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1844 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1845 both signals.
1846
1847 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1848 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1849 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1850 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1851 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1852 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1853 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1854 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1855 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1856 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1857 not available.)
1858
1859 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1860 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1861 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1862 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1863 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1864 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1865 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1866 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1867
1868 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1869 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1870 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1871 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1872 slower clock than they will use later.
1873 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1874 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1875 than they will use later.
1876 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1877
1878 @quotation Important
1879 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1880 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1881 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1882 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1883 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1884 @end quotation
1885
1886 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1887 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1888 @cindex init_targets procedure
1889
1890 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1891 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1892 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1893 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1894 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1895 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1896 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1897 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1898 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1899
1900 @example
1901 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1902
1903 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1904 # basic initialization procedure ...
1905 @}
1906
1907 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1908 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1909 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1910 @}
1911
1912 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1913
1914 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1919 @}
1920 @end example
1921
1922 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1923 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1924
1925 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1926
1927 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1928 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1929
1930 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1931 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1932 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1933
1934 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1935 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1936 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1938 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1939 events already assigned.
1940
1941 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1942
1943 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1944 special high speed download features - enable it.
1945
1946 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1947
1948 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1949 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1950 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1951 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1952 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1953 If you are using an external trace port,
1954 configure it in your board config file.
1955 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1956 configure it in your target config file.
1957
1958 @example
1959 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1960 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1964
1965 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1966
1967 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1968 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1969 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1970 the TARGET (chip) file.
1971
1972 Examples:
1973 @itemize @bullet
1974 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1975 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1976 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1977 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1978 @end itemize
1979
1980 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1981 @section Translating Configuration Files
1982 @cindex translation
1983 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1984 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1985 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1986 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1987 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1988 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1989
1990 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1991 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1992 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1993 convert other scripts later on.
1994
1995 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1996 replace job:
1997
1998 @example
1999 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2000 #
2001 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2002 #
2003 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2004 #
2005 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2006
2007 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2008 global TARGETNAME
2009
2010 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2011
2012 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2014 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2015 @}
2016 @end example
2017
2018
2019
2020 @node Server Configuration
2021 @chapter Server Configuration
2022 @cindex initialization
2023 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2024 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2025 supported.
2026
2027 @anchor{configurationstage}
2028 @section Configuration Stage
2029 @cindex configuration stage
2030 @cindex config command
2031
2032 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2033 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2034 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2035 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2036 inside startup scripts.
2037
2038 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2039 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2040 which may be issued interactively.
2041 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2042 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2043
2044 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2045 flash banks,
2046 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2047 and other basic setup.
2048 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2049 may access or activate TAPs.
2050 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2051 longer be issued.
2052
2053 @deffn {Command} {command mode} [command_name]
2054 Returns the command modes allowed by a command: 'any', 'config', or
2055 'exec'. If no command is specified, returns the current command
2056 mode. Returns 'unknown' if an unknown command is given. Command can be
2057 multiple tokens. (command valid any time)
2058
2059 In this document, the modes are described as stages, 'config' and
2060 'exec' mode correspond configuration stage and run stage. 'any' means
2061 the command can be executed in either
2062 stages. @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}, and
2063 @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.
2064 @end deffn
2065
2066 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2067 @section Entering the Run Stage
2068
2069 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2070 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2071 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2072 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2073 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2074 You should see no errors at this point.
2075 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2076 commands you used to configure the server.
2077 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2078 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2079 on the scan chain.
2080
2081 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2082 become available.
2083 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2084 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2085 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2086 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2087 entry to the run stage.
2088
2089 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2090 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2091 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2092 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2093 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2094 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2095 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2096
2097 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2098 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2099 configuration files and/or command line options.
2100
2101 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs near the end of your
2102 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2103 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2104 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2105 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2106
2107 @command{init} calls the following internal OpenOCD commands to initialize
2108 corresponding subsystems:
2109 @deffn {Config Command} {target init}
2110 @deffnx {Command} {transport init}
2111 @deffnx {Command} {dap init}
2112 @deffnx {Config Command} {flash init}
2113 @deffnx {Config Command} {nand init}
2114 @deffnx {Config Command} {pld init}
2115 @deffnx {Command} {tpiu init}
2116 @end deffn
2117 @end deffn
2118
2119 @deffn {Config Command} {noinit}
2120 Prevent OpenOCD from implicit @command{init} call at the end of startup.
2121 Allows issuing configuration commands over telnet or Tcl connection.
2122 When you are done with configuration use @command{init} to enter
2123 the run stage.
2124 @end deffn
2125
2126 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2127 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2128 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2129
2130 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2131 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2132 scan chain.
2133 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2134 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2135
2136 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2137 they return.
2138 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2139 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2140 @end deffn
2141
2142 @anchor{tcpipports}
2143 @section TCP/IP Ports
2144 @cindex TCP port
2145 @cindex server
2146 @cindex port
2147 @cindex security
2148 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2149 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2150 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2151
2152 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2153 access using one or more of these ports.
2154 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2155 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2156 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2157
2158 @anchor{gdb_port}
2159 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2160 @cindex GDB server
2161 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2162 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2163 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2164 the normal use cases.
2165
2166 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2167 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2168 disables the gdb server.
2169
2170 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2171 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2172
2173 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2174 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2175 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2176
2177 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2178 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2179 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2180 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2181 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2182 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2183 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2184 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2185 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2186
2187 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2188 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2189 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2190 @end deffn
2191
2192 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2193 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2194 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2195 output from the Tcl engine.
2196 Intended as a machine interface.
2197 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2198 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2199 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2200 @end deffn
2201
2202 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2203 Specify or query the
2204 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2205 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2206 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2207 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2208 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2212 @section GDB Configuration
2213 @cindex GDB
2214 @cindex GDB configuration
2215 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2216 The ones listed here are static and global.
2217 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2218 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2219
2220 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2221 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2222 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2223 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2224 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2225 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2226 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2230 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2232 vFlash packet is received.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2234 @end deffn
2235
2236 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2237 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2238 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2239 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2240 for flash programming to work.
2241 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2242 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2243 @end deffn
2244
2245 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2246 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2247 by GDB memory read packets.
2248 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2249 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2250 @end deffn
2251
2252 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2253 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2254 packets report errors or not.
2255 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2256 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2257 @end deffn
2258
2259 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2260 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2261 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2262 @end deffn
2263
2264 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2265 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2266
2267 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2268 @end deffn
2269
2270 @anchor{eventpolling}
2271 @section Event Polling
2272
2273 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2274 where significant events can happen at any time.
2275 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2276 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2277 or to GDB.
2278
2279 Examples of such events include:
2280
2281 @itemize
2282 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2283 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2284 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2285 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2286 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2287 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2288 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2289 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2290 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2291 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2292 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2293 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2294 @end itemize
2295
2296 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2297 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2298 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2299 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2300 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2301
2302 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2303 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2304 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2305 to the various active targets.
2306 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2307 which is normally done in the background.
2308
2309 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2310 Poll the current target for its current state.
2311 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2312 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2313 specific information about the current state is printed.
2314 An optional parameter
2315 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2316
2317 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2318 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2319 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2320 @example
2321 > poll
2322 background polling: on
2323 target state: halted
2324 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2325 current mode: Supervisor
2326 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2327 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2328 >
2329 @end example
2330 @end deffn
2331
2332 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2333 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2334 @cindex config file, interface
2335 @cindex interface config file
2336
2337 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2338 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2339 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2340
2341 @quotation Note
2342 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2343 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2344 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2345 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2346 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2347 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2348 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2349 @end quotation
2350
2351 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2352 through commands in an interface configuration
2353 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2354 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2355
2356 @example
2357 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2358 @end example
2359
2360 These commands tell
2361 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2362 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2363
2364 @example
2365 # jlink interface
2366 adapter driver jlink
2367 @end example
2368
2369 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2370
2371
2372 @section Adapter Configuration
2373
2374 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2375 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2376 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2377
2378 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2379 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2380 target.
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2384 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2385 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2386 @end deffn
2387 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2388 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2389 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2390 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2391 the hardware can support.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394
2395
2396 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2397 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2401 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2402 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2403 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2404 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2405 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2406 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2407
2408 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2409 @end deffn
2410
2411 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2412 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2413 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2414 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2415 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2416 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2417 @end deffn
2418
2419 @section Interface Drivers
2420
2421 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2422 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2423 available at run time.
2424
2425 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2426 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2427 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2428 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2429
2430 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2431 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2432 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2436 Displays status of RTCK option.
2437 Optionally sets that option first.
2438 @end deffn
2439 @end deffn
2440
2441 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2442 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2443 This has one driver-specific command:
2444
2445 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2446 Logs some status
2447 @end deffn
2448 @end deffn
2449
2450 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2451 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2452 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2453 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2454 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2455 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2456 @end deffn
2457
2458 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2459 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2460 or v2 (USB bulk).
2461
2462 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2463 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2464 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2465 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2466 @example
2467 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2468 @end example
2469 @end deffn
2470
2471 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2472 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2473
2474 @itemize @minus
2475 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2476 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2477 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2478 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2479 @end itemize
2480 @end deffn
2481
2482 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2483 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2484 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2485 interface string or for user class interface.
2486 @end deffn
2487
2488 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2489 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2490 @end deffn
2491
2492 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2493 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2494 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2495
2496 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2497 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2498 are logged.
2499 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2500 @end deffn
2501 @end deffn
2502
2503 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2504 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2505 @end deffn
2506
2507 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2508 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2509 @end deffn
2510
2511 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2512 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2513 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2514
2515 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2516 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2517
2518 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2519 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2520
2521 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2522 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2523 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2524 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2525 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2526 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2527
2528 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2529 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2530 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2531 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2532 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2533
2534 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2535 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2536 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2537 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2538
2539 @itemize @minus
2540 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2541 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2542 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2543 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2544 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2545 switching data and direction as necessary
2546 @end itemize
2547
2548 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2549 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2550
2551 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2552 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2553 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2554 @example
2555 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2556 @end example
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2560 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2561 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2562 during device selection.
2563 @end deffn
2564
2565 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2566 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2567 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2568 @end deffn
2569
2570 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2571 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2572 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2573 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2574 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2575 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2576 and initially asserted reset signals.
2577 @end deffn
2578
2579 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2580 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2581 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2582 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2583 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2584 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2585 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2586 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2587 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2588 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2589 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2590
2591 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2592 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2593 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2594 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2595 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2596 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2597
2598 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2599 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2600 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2601 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2602 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2603 are always driven by the FTDI.
2604
2605 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2606 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2607 @var{name}.
2608 @end deffn
2609
2610 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2611 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2612 @itemize @minus
2613 @item @option{0}, drive low
2614 @item @option{1}, drive high
2615 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2616 @end itemize
2617 @end deffn
2618
2619 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2620 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2621 @end deffn
2622
2623 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2624 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2625
2626 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2627 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2628 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2629 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2630 @itemize @minus
2631 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2632 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2633 @end itemize
2634 @end deffn
2635
2636 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2637 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2638
2639 @end deffn
2640
2641 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2642 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2643 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2644 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2645
2646 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2647 @itemize @minus
2648 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2649 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2650 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2651 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2652 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2653 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2654 @end itemize
2655
2656 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2657 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2658 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2659 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2660 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2661 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2662 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2663 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2664
2665 FT232R
2666 @itemize @minus
2667 @item bit 7 - RI
2668 @item bit 6 - DCD
2669 @item bit 5 - DSR
2670 @item bit 4 - DTR
2671 @item bit 3 - CTS
2672 @item bit 2 - RTS
2673 @item bit 1 - RXD
2674 @item bit 0 - TXD
2675 @end itemize
2676
2677 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2678 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2679
2680 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2681 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2682 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2686 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2687 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2691 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2695 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2696 @end deffn
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2699 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2703 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2707 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2711 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2712 @end deffn
2713
2714 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2715 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2716 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2717 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2718 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2719 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2720 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2721 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2722 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2723 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2729 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2730 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2731 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2732
2733 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2734 processors which are being simulated.
2735
2736 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2737 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2738 sockets instead of TCP.
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2742 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2743 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2747 something like:
2748
2749 @example
2750 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2751 remote_bitbang port 3335
2752 remote_bitbang host foobar
2753 @end example
2754
2755 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2756 named mysocket:
2757
2758 @example
2759 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2760 remote_bitbang port 0
2761 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2766 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2767 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2768 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2769
2770 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2771 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2772 default values are used.
2773 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2774 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2775 @example
2776 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2777 @end example
2778 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2779 @example
2780 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2781 @end example
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2785 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2786 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2787 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2788 target board.
2789
2790 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2791 @example
2792 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2793 reset_config srst_only
2794 @end example
2795 @end deffn
2796
2797 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2798 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2799 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2800 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2801 @end deffn
2802
2803 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2804 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2805 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2806 @end deffn
2807
2808 @end deffn
2809
2810 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2811 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2812 This has one driver-specific command:
2813
2814 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2815 Display either the address of the I/O port
2816 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2817 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2818 This is a write-once setting.
2819 @end deffn
2820 @end deffn
2821
2822 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2823 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2824 transports.
2825
2826 @quotation Compatibility Note
2827 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2828 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2829 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2830 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2831 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2832 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2833 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2834 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2835 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2836 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2837 @end quotation
2838
2839 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2840 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2841 states.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2844 Display free device internal memory.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2847 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2848 command version.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2851 Display the device configuration.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2854 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2855 power state.
2856 @end deffn
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2858 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2861 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2862 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2863 IP configuration.
2864 @end deffn
2865 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2866 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2867 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2868 @end deffn
2869 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2870 Reset the current configuration.
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2873 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2876 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2877 pairs.
2878
2879 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2880 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2881 @example
2882 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2883 @end example
2884 @end deffn
2885 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2886 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2887 pairs.
2888
2889 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2890 @example
2891 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2892 77a90000
2893 @end example
2894 @end deffn
2895 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2896 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2897 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2898 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2899 the serial number instead, if possible.
2900
2901 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2902 @end deffn
2903 @end deffn
2904
2905 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2906 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2907 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2908 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2909 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2910 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2911 configuration script.
2912
2913 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2914 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2915 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2916 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2917 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2918
2919 Known limitations:
2920 @itemize @bullet
2921 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2922 and 2.7 MHz.
2923 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2924 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2925 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2926 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2927 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2928 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2929 communications with the target.
2930 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2931 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2932 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2933 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2934 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2935 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2936 @end itemize
2937
2938 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2939 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2940 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2944 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2945 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2946 target as a side-effect.
2947 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2948 @end deffn
2949
2950 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2951 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2952 version, and target voltage.
2953 @end deffn
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2957 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2958 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2959 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2960 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2961
2962 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2963 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2964 This is a write-once setting.
2965 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2966
2967 @itemize @minus
2968 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2969 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2970 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2971 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2972 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2973 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2974 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2975 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2976 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2977 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2978 some versions of
2979 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2980 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2981 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2982 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2983 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2984 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2985 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2986 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2987 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2988 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2989 @end itemize
2990 @end deffn
2991
2992 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2993 Display either the address of the I/O port
2994 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2995 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2996 This is a write-once setting.
2997
2998 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2999 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
3000 you may encounter a problem.
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3004 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3005 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3006 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3007 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3008 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3009
3010 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3011 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3012 @quotation Tip
3013 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3014 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3015 @example
3016 > parport toggling_time 1000
3017 > adapter speed 500
3018 @end example
3019 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3020 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3021 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3022 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3023 large set of samples.
3024 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3025 @example
3026 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3027 @end example
3028 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3029 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3030
3031 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3032 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3033 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3034 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3035 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3036 be conservative.
3037 @end quotation
3038 @end deffn
3039
3040 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3041 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3042 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3043 @end deffn
3044
3045 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3046 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3047
3048 @example
3049 adapter driver parport
3050 parport port 0x278
3051 parport cable wiggler
3052 @end example
3053 @end deffn
3054
3055 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3056 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3060 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3064 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3065 @end deffn
3066
3067 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3068 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3069
3070 @quotation Note
3071 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3072 which are not currently documented here.
3073 @end quotation
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @anchor{hla_interface}
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3078 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3079 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3080 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3081
3082 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3083 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3084 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3085 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3086 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3087 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3090 Currently Not Supported.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3094 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3098 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3099 @end deffn
3100
3101 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3102 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3103 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3104
3105 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3106 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3107 ST-LINK server software module}.
3108 @end deffn
3109
3110 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3111 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3112 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3113 @end deffn
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3117 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3118 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3119 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3120 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3121
3122 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3123 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3124 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3125 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3126
3127 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3128 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3129
3130 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3131 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3132 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3133
3134 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3135 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3136 ST-LINK server software module}.
3137
3138 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3142 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3143 @end deffn
3144
3145 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3146 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3147 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3148
3149 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3150 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3151 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3152 the target's supply voltage.
3153 @example
3154 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3155 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3156 @end example
3157 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3158 @example
3159 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3160 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3161 3.24891518738
3162 @end example
3163 @end deffn
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3167 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3171 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3172 @end deffn
3173
3174 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3175 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3176 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3177 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3178 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3179
3180 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3181 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3182 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3183 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3184 @end deffn
3185
3186 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3187 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3188 version).
3189 @end deffn
3190 @end deffn
3191
3192 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3193 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3194 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3195 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3196 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3197
3198 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3199
3200 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3201 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3202
3203 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3204 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3205
3206 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3207
3208 @end deffn
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3212 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3213 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3214
3215 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3216 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3217 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3218 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3219 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3220 configuration on exit.
3221
3222 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3223
3224 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3225 pinout.
3226
3227 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3228 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3229 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3230 individually.
3231 @end deffn
3232
3233 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3234 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3235 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3236 @end deffn
3237
3238 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3239 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3240 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3241 @end deffn
3242
3243 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3244 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3245 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3246 @end deffn
3247
3248 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3249 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3250 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3254 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3255 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3256 @end deffn
3257
3258 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3259 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3260 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3261 @end deffn
3262
3263 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3264 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3265 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3266 @end deffn
3267
3268 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3269 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3270 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3271 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3275 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3276 @end deffn
3277
3278 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3279 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3283 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3284 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3285 @end deffn
3286
3287 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3288 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3289 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3290 list can be found in the
3291 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3292 @end deffn
3293
3294 @end deffn
3295
3296 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3297 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3298 of the one which is most popular.
3299
3300 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3301
3302 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3303 pinout.
3304
3305 @end deffn
3306
3307
3308 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3309 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3310 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3311
3312 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3313 @end deffn
3314
3315
3316 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3317 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3318 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3319
3320 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3321 @end deffn
3322
3323
3324 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3325 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3326 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3327
3328 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3329 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3330 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3331
3332 @itemize @minus
3333 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3334 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3335 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3336 @end itemize
3337 @end deffn
3338
3339 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3340 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3341 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3342 @end deffn
3343 @end deffn
3344
3345
3346 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3347 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3348 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3349 DPI server interface.
3350
3351 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3352 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3353 @end deffn
3354
3355 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3356 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3357 @end deffn
3358 @end deffn
3359
3360
3361 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3362
3363 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3364 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3365
3366 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3367 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3368
3369 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3370 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3371 @example
3372 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3373 @end example
3374 @end deffn
3375
3376 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3377 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3378 @example
3379 buspirate speed normal
3380 @end example
3381 @end deffn
3382
3383 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3384 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3385 @itemize @minus
3386 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3387 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3388 @end itemize
3389 For example:
3390 @example
3391 buspirate mode normal
3392 @end example
3393 @end deffn
3394
3395 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3396 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3397 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3398 For example:
3399 @example
3400 buspirate pullup 0
3401 @end example
3402 @end deffn
3403
3404 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3405 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3406 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3407 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3408 @example
3409 buspirate vreg 0
3410 @end example
3411 @end deffn
3412
3413 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3414 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3415 @end deffn
3416 @example
3417 buspirate led 1
3418 @end example
3419
3420 @end deffn
3421
3422
3423 @section Transport Configuration
3424 @cindex Transport
3425 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3426 and the debug adapter you are using,
3427 several transports may be available to
3428 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3429 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3430 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3431 version of OpenOCD.
3432 @end deffn
3433
3434 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3435 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3436
3437 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3438 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3439 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3440 adapter's driver).
3441
3442 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3443 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3444 supported by the debug adapter.
3445
3446 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3447 transport, if any.
3448 @end deffn
3449
3450 @subsection JTAG Transport
3451 @cindex JTAG
3452 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3453 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3454 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3455 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3456 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3457 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3458
3459 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3460 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3461 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3462 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3463 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3464
3465 @subsection SWD Transport
3466 @cindex SWD
3467 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3468 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3469 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3470 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3471 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3472 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3473 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3474
3475 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3476 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3477 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3478 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3479 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3480
3481 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3482 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3483 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3484 expected to change.
3485 @end deffn
3486
3487 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3488 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3489 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3490 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3491 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3492 DAPs are created.
3493
3494 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3495 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3496 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3497
3498 @subsection SPI Transport
3499 @cindex SPI
3500 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3501 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3502 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3503 solution for flash programming.
3504
3505 @anchor{swimtransport}
3506 @subsection SWIM Transport
3507 @cindex SWIM
3508 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3509 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3510 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3511 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3512
3513 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3514
3515 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3516
3517 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3518 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3519 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3520 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3521 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3522
3523 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3524 @section JTAG Speed
3525 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3526 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3527 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3528 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3529 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3530 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3531 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3532 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3533 power management software that may be active.
3534
3535 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3536 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3537 target event handler.
3538 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3539 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3540 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3541 sets up those clocks).
3542 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3543 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3544 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3545 in the target config file.
3546 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3547 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3548 config file instead.
3549 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3550 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3551 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3552
3553 @example
3554 jtag_rclk 3000
3555 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3556 @end example
3557
3558 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3559 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3560 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3561 may not be the fastest solution.
3562
3563 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3564 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3565 which support adaptive clocking.
3566
3567 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3568 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3569 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3570 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3571 than the speed specified.
3572
3573 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3574 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3575 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3576 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3577
3578 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3579 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3580 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3581 JTAG clocking after setup.
3582 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3583 If the interface device can not
3584 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3585 @end deffn
3586
3587 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3588 @cindex adaptive clocking
3589 @cindex RTCK
3590 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3591 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3592 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3593 @example
3594 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3595 jtag_rclk 3000
3596 @end example
3597 @end defun
3598
3599 @node Reset Configuration
3600 @chapter Reset Configuration
3601 @cindex Reset Configuration
3602
3603 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3604 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3605 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3606 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3607 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3608 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3609 Please see the various board files for examples.
3610
3611 @quotation Note
3612 To maintainers and integrators:
3613 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3614 Normally the board configuration file
3615 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3616 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3617
3618 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3619 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3620 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3621 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3622 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3623 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3624 @end quotation
3625
3626 @section Types of Reset
3627
3628 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3629 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3630 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3631
3632 @itemize @bullet
3633 @item
3634 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3635 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3636 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3637 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3638 @item
3639 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3640 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3641 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3642 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3643 @item
3644 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3645 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3646 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3647 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3648 @item
3649 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3650 several other types of reset.
3651 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3652 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3653 There may be individual module resets.
3654 @end itemize
3655
3656 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3657 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3658 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3659 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3660 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3661 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3662 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3663 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3664 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3665
3666 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3667 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3668
3669 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3670 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3671 common issues are:
3672
3673 @itemize @bullet
3674
3675 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3676 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3677 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3678 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3679 when either of those signals is not connected.
3680 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3681 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3682 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3683 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3684
3685 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3686 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3687 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3688 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3689
3690 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3691 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3692 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3693 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3694 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3695 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3696 hardware debouncing.
3697 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3698 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3699
3700 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3701 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3702 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3703 to use push/pull output drivers.
3704 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3705 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3706 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3707 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3708
3709 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3710 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3711 issues (not limited to errata).
3712 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3713 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3714 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3715 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3716 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3717 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3718 @end itemize
3719
3720 There can also be other issues.
3721 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3722 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3723 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3724 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3725 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3726 Agreement (NDA).
3727
3728 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3729 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3730 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3731
3732 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3733 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3734
3735 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3736
3737 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3738 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3739 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3740 allowing it to be deasserted.
3741 @end deffn
3742
3743 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3744 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3745 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3746 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3747 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3748 @end deffn
3749
3750 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3751 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3752 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3753 allowing it to be deasserted.
3754 @end deffn
3755
3756 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3757 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3758 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3759 @end deffn
3760
3761 @anchor{reset_config}
3762 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3763 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3764 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3765 configuration scripts.
3766
3767 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3768 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3769 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3770 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3771 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3772 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3773 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3774 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3775
3776 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3777 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3778 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3779 -- may be specified at a time.
3780 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3781 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3782 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3783 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3784 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3785
3786 @itemize
3787 @item
3788 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3789 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3790 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3791 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3792 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3793
3794 @quotation Tip
3795 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3796 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3797 @end quotation
3798
3799 @item
3800 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3801 signal implementations.
3802 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3803 indicating everything behaves normally.
3804 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3805 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3806 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3807 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3808 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3809 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3810 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3811
3812 @item
3813 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3814 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3815 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3816 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3817 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3818 while SRST is asserted.
3819 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3820 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3821
3822 @item
3823 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3824 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3825 is required to use this option.
3826 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3827 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3828 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3829 be asserted before any target connection.
3830 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3831 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3832 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3833 @end itemize
3834
3835 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3836 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3837 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3838 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3839 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3840
3841 @itemize
3842 @item
3843 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3844 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3845 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3846 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3847
3848 @item
3849 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3850 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3851 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3852 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3853 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3854 @end itemize
3855 @end deffn
3856
3857 @section Custom Reset Handling
3858 @cindex events
3859
3860 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3861 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3862 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3863 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3864 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3865 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3866
3867 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3868 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3869 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3870 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3871 want to reset everything at once.
3872
3873 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3874 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3875 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3876 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3877 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3878 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3879 needs special attention.
3880
3881 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3882 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3883 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3884 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3885 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3886 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3887 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3888 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3889 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3890
3891 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3892 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3893 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3894 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3895 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3896
3897 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3898 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3899 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3900 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3901 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3902 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3903 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3904 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3905 or potentially some other value.
3906
3907 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3908 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3909 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3910 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3911 (or their associated targets)
3912 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3913
3914 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3915 they return.
3916 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3917 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3918 @end deffn
3919
3920 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3921 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3922 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3923 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3924 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3925 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3926 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3927 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3928 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3929 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3930 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3931 @end deffn
3932
3933 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3934 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3935 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3936 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3937 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3938 @end deffn
3939
3940
3941 @node TAP Declaration
3942 @chapter TAP Declaration
3943 @cindex TAP declaration
3944 @cindex TAP configuration
3945
3946 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3947 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3948
3949 @itemize @bullet
3950 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3951 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3952 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3953 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3954 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3955 start running that code.
3956 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3957 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3958 and missing connections.
3959 @end itemize
3960
3961 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3962 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3963 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3964 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3965 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3966
3967 @section Scan Chains
3968 @cindex scan chain
3969
3970 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3971 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3972 They also need to be added to
3973 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3974 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3975 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3976 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3977 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3978 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3979 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3980 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3981
3982 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3983 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3984 command, presented in the next chapter.
3985 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3986 debugging targets.)
3987 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3988
3989 @verbatim
3990 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3991 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3992 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3993 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3994 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3995 @end verbatim
3996
3997 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3998 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3999 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
4000 because not all devices provide good support for that.
4001 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
4002 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
4003 until they are told to do so.
4004
4005 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
4006 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
4007 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
4008 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
4009
4010 @example
4011 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
4012 @end example
4013
4014 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
4015 by a given chip.
4016 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
4017 and so forth.
4018 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
4019 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
4020 both inside a single chip and between them.
4021 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
4022
4023 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
4024 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
4025 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
4026 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
4027 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
4028 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
4029 includes commands something like this:
4030
4031 @example
4032 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
4033 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
4034 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
4035 @end example
4036
4037 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
4038 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
4039 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
4040
4041 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4042 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4043 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4044 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4045 @example
4046 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4047 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4048 @}
4049 @end example
4050 @end deffn
4051
4052 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4053 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4054 and their status.
4055 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4056 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4057 but systems with a JTAG router can
4058 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4059 @end deffn
4060
4061 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4062 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4063
4064 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4065 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4066
4067 @section TAP Names
4068 @cindex dotted name
4069
4070 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4071 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4072 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4073 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4074 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4075 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4076 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4077 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4078
4079 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4080 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4081 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4082
4083 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4084
4085 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4086 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4087 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4088
4089 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4090 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4091 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4092 overridable.
4093
4094 @cindex TAP naming convention
4095 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4096 and should follow this convention:
4097
4098 @itemize @bullet
4099 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4100 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4101 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4102 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4103 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4104 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4105 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4106 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4107 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4108 with a single TAP;
4109 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4110 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4111 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4112 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4113 @end itemize
4114
4115 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4116
4117 @itemize @bullet
4118 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4119 @*The length in bits of the
4120 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4121 @end itemize
4122
4123 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4124
4125 @itemize @bullet
4126 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4127 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4128 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4129 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4130 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4131 (the TAP is linked in).
4132 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4133 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4134 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4135 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4136 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4137 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4138 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4139 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4140 values that were found but not included in the list.
4141
4142 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4143 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4144 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4145 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4146 hardware to find these values.
4147 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4148 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4149 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4150 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4151 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4152 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4153 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4154 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4155 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4156 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4157 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4158 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4159 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4160 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4161 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4162 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4163 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4164 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4165 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4166 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4167 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4168 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4169 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4170 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4171 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4172 @end itemize
4173 @end deffn
4174
4175 @section Other TAP commands
4176
4177 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4178 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4179 @end deffn
4180
4181 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4182 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4183 At this writing this TAP attribute
4184 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4185 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4186 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4187 See the next section for information about the available events.
4188
4189 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4190 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4191 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4192 @end deffn
4193
4194 @section TAP Events
4195 @cindex events
4196 @cindex TAP events
4197
4198 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4199 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4200 The other applies to debugger targets,
4201 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4202
4203 The TAP events currently defined are:
4204
4205 @itemize @bullet
4206 @item @b{post-reset}
4207 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4208 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4209 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4210 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4211 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4212
4213 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4214 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4215 of any particular target.
4216 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4217 @item @b{setup}
4218 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4219 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4220 @item @b{tap-disable}
4221 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4222 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4223 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4224 @item @b{tap-enable}
4225 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4226 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4227 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4228 @end itemize
4229
4230 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4231 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4232 contents to be accurate), you might:
4233
4234 @example
4235 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4236 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4237 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4238 @}
4239 @end example
4240
4241
4242 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4243 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4244 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4245 @cindex jrc
4246
4247 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4248 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4249 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4250 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4251 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4252
4253 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4254 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4255 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4256 be visible.
4257 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4258 ignores, such as:
4259
4260 @itemize
4261 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4262 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4263 TAPs receive new instructions.
4264 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4265 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4266 @end itemize
4267
4268 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4269 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4270 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4271 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4272
4273 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4274 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4275
4276 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4277 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4278 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4279 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4280 should define TAP event handlers using
4281 code that looks something like this:
4282
4283 @example
4284 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4285 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4286 @}
4287 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4288 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4289 @}
4290 @end example
4291
4292 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4293
4294 @example
4295 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4296 @end example
4297
4298 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4299 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4300 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4301 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4302
4303 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4304 If necessary, disables the tap
4305 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4306 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4307 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4308 and "0" if it is disabled.
4309 @end deffn
4310
4311 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4312 If necessary, enables the tap
4313 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4314 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4315 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4316 and "0" if it is disabled.
4317 @end deffn
4318
4319 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4320 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4321 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4322 and "0" if it is disabled.
4323
4324 @quotation Note
4325 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4326 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4327 @end quotation
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @anchor{autoprobing}
4331 @section Autoprobing
4332 @cindex autoprobe
4333 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4334
4335 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4336 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4337 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4338 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4339
4340 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4341 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4342 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4343 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4344 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4345 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4346 right when they come out of reset).
4347
4348 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4349
4350 @example
4351 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4352 reset_config trst_and_srst
4353 jtag_rclk 8
4354 @end example
4355
4356 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4357 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4358
4359 @enumerate
4360 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4361 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4362 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4363 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4364 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4365 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4366 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4367 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4368 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4369 that is discovered.
4370 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4371 register, it will report it.
4372 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4373 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4374 @end enumerate
4375
4376 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4377 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4378 that's a bit more complex:
4379
4380 @example
4381 clock speed 8 kHz
4382 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4383 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4384 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4385 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4386 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4387 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4388 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4389 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4390 @end example
4391
4392 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4393 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4394 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4395 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4396 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4397 and so forth.
4398
4399 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4400 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4401 @cindex DAP declaration
4402
4403 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4404 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4405 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4406 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4407 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4408
4409 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4410
4411 @anchor{dap_create}
4412 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4413 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4414 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4415 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4416 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4417
4418 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4419
4420 @itemize @bullet
4421 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4422 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4423 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4424 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4425 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4426
4427 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4428 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4429 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4430 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4431 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4432 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4433
4434 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4435 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4436 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4437 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4438 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4439 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4440 @end itemize
4441 @end deffn
4442
4443 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4444 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4445 for TCL scripting.
4446 @end deffn
4447
4448 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4449 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4450 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4451 @end deffn
4452
4453 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4454 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4455 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4456 initialization, too.
4457 @end deffn
4458
4459 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4460
4461 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4462 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4463 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4464 @end deffn
4465
4466 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4467 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4468 @end deffn
4469
4470 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4471 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4472 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4473 or set a new value @var{value}.
4474 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4475 @end deffn
4476
4477 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4478 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4479 @end deffn
4480
4481 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4482 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4483 value @var{value}.
4484
4485 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4486 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4487 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4488
4489 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4490 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4491 @end deffn
4492
4493 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4494 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4495 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4496 @end deffn
4497
4498 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4499 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4500 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4501 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4502 @end deffn
4503
4504 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4505 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4506
4507 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4508 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4509 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4510 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4511 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4512 for details.
4513
4514 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4515 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4516 the pattern:
4517 @example
4518 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4519 @end example
4520
4521 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4522 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4523 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4524 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4525 @example
4526 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4527 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4528 @end example
4529
4530 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4531 @example
4532 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4533 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4534 @end example
4535
4536 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4537 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4538
4539 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4540 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4541 example with a proper dap name:
4542 @example
4543 xxx.dap apcsw default
4544 @end example
4545 @end deffn
4546
4547 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4548 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4549 Disabled by default
4550 @end deffn
4551
4552
4553 @node CPU Configuration
4554 @chapter CPU Configuration
4555 @cindex GDB target
4556
4557 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4558 You can also access these targets without GDB
4559 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4560 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4561 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4562 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4563
4564 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4565 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4566
4567 @section Target List
4568 @cindex target, current
4569 @cindex target, list
4570
4571 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4572 where each member has a name.
4573 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4574 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4575 (plural!) command.
4576 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4577 look like with more than one:
4578 @verbatim
4579 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4580 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4581 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4582 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4583 @end verbatim
4584
4585 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4586 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4587 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4588 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4589 space seen by that current target.
4590 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4591 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4592 are examples; and there are many more.
4593
4594 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4595
4596 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4597 Returns the name of the current target.
4598 @end deffn
4599
4600 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4601 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4602 @example
4603 foreach t [target names] @{
4604 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4605 @}
4606 @end example
4607 @end deffn
4608
4609 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4610 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4611
4612 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4613 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4614 command names are singular.}
4615
4616 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4617 targets in a user friendly form.
4618
4619 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4620 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4621 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4622 @end deffn
4623
4624 @section Target CPU Types
4625 @cindex target type
4626 @cindex CPU type
4627
4628 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4629 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4630 when calling @command{target create}.
4631 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4632 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4633 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4634 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4635 what core-specific commands may be available
4636 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4637 and more.
4638
4639 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4640 since there's a command to list them.
4641
4642 @anchor{targettypes}
4643 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4644 Lists all supported target types.
4645 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4646
4647 @itemize @bullet
4648 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4649 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4650 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4651 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4652 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4653 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4654 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4655 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4656 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4657 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4658 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4659 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4660 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4661 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4662 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4663 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4664 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4665 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4666 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4667 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4668 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4669 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4670 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4671 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4672 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4673 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4674 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4675 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4676 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4677 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4678 support for new CPUs.
4679 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4680 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4681 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4682 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4683 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4684 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4685 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4686 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4687 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4688 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4689 @itemize @minus
4690 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4691 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4692 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4693 @end itemize
4694 And two debug interfaces cores:
4695 @itemize @minus
4696 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4697 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4698 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4699 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4700 @end itemize
4701 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4702 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4703 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4704 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4705 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4706 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4707 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4708 @end itemize
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4712 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4713 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4714 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4715 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4716 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4717 reflect design generations;
4718 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4719 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4720
4721 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4722 @section Target Configuration
4723
4724 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4725 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4726 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4727 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4728 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4729
4730 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4731 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4732 optional parts.
4733 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4734 command, created as part of target creation.
4735
4736 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4737 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4738 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4739 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4740 to be much more board-specific.
4741 The key steps you use might look something like this
4742
4743 @example
4744 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4745 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4746 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4747 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4748 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4749 @end example
4750
4751 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4752 on-chip SRAM.
4753 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4754 writes to target memory;
4755 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4756 GDB memory checksumming;
4757 and more.
4758
4759 @quotation Warning
4760 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4761 inaccessible when application code
4762 (such as an operating system)
4763 enables or disables the MMU.
4764 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4765 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4766 easy access to other addresses needed.
4767 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4768 @end quotation
4769
4770 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4771 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4772 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4773 controllers.
4774 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4775 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4776 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4777
4778 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4779 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4780 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4781 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4782 purposes including additional configuration.
4783
4784 @itemize @bullet
4785 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4786 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4787 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4788 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4789
4790 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4791 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4792 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4793 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4794 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4795 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4796 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4797
4798 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4799 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4800 @end itemize
4801 @end deffn
4802
4803 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4804 The options accepted by this command may also be
4805 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4806 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4807 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4808
4809 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4810 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4811 and changing its endianness.
4812
4813 @itemize @bullet
4814
4815 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4816 used to access this target.
4817
4818 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4819 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4820 create and manage DAP instances.
4821
4822 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4823 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4824
4825 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4826 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4827 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4828 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4829 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4830 same event name assigns only one handler.
4831
4832 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4833 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4834
4835 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4836 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4837 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4838 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4839 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4840 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4841 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4842
4843 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4844 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4845 or virtual address is being used.
4846
4847 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4848 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4849
4850 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4851 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4852 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4853 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4854 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4855
4856 @anchor{rtostype}
4857 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4858 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4859 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4860 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4861 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4862 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4863
4864 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4865 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4866 access the target for debugging.
4867
4868 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4869 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4870 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4871 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4872
4873 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4874 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4875 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4876 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4877 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4878
4879 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4880 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4881 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4882 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4883 command @command{gdb_port}.
4884 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4885
4886 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4887 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4888 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4889 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4890 @end itemize
4891 @end deffn
4892
4893 @section Other $target_name Commands
4894 @cindex object command
4895
4896 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4897 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4898
4899 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4900 Once a button is created a button
4901 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4902 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4903 configure it like this:
4904
4905 @example
4906 # Create
4907 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4908 # Modify
4909 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4910 # Query
4911 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4912 # Report
4913 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4914 @end example
4915
4916 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4917 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4918
4919 @example
4920 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4921 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4922 @end example
4923
4924 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4925
4926 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4927 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4928 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4929 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4930 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4931 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4932 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4933 They are not otherwise documented here.
4934 @end deffn
4935
4936 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4937 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4938 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4939 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4940 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4941 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4942 the target side uses raw memory.
4943
4944 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4945 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4946 The script orientation comes from working with data
4947 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4948 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4949 and neither store nor return those values.
4950
4951 @itemize
4952 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4953 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4954 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4955 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4956 @end itemize
4957 @end deffn
4958
4959 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4960 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4961 @command{$target_name configure}
4962 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4963 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4964 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4965 There are a few special cases:
4966
4967 @itemize @bullet
4968 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4969 event named @var{event_name}.
4970 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4971 two parameters.
4972 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4973 This is a special case because this is set using
4974 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4975 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4976 @end itemize
4977
4978 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4979 all the targets you might use something like this:
4980
4981 @example
4982 foreach name [target names] @{
4983 set y [$name cget -endian]
4984 set z [$name cget -type]
4985 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4986 $x $name $y $z]
4987 @}
4988 @end example
4989 @end deffn
4990
4991 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4992 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4993 Displays the current target state:
4994 @code{debug-running},
4995 @code{halted},
4996 @code{reset},
4997 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4998 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4999 @end deffn
5000
5001 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
5002 Displays a table listing all event handlers
5003 currently associated with this target.
5004 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
5005 @end deffn
5006
5007 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
5008 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
5009 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
5010 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
5011 @end deffn
5012
5013 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
5014 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
5015 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
5016 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
5017 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5018 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
5019 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5020 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5021 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5022 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5023 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5024 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5025 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5026 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
5027 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
5028 @end deffn
5029
5030 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
5031 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
5032 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
5033 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
5034 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5035 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
5036 at the specified address @var{addr}.
5037 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
5038 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
5039 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
5040 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5041 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5042 @end deffn
5043
5044 @anchor{targetevents}
5045 @section Target Events
5046 @cindex target events
5047 @cindex events
5048 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5049 For example:
5050 @itemize @bullet
5051 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5052 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5053 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5054 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5055 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5056 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5057 to set up system clocks or
5058 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5059 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5060 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5061 @end itemize
5062
5063 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5064 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5065 @command{target create ... -event}.
5066
5067 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5068 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5069 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5070
5071 @example
5072 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5073 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5074 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5075 @}
5076 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5077 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5078 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5079 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5080 @}
5081 @end example
5082
5083 The following target events are defined:
5084
5085 @itemize @bullet
5086 @item @b{debug-halted}
5087 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5088 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5089 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5090 @item @b{early-halted}
5091 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5092 @item @b{examine-start}
5093 @* Before target examine is called.
5094 @item @b{examine-end}
5095 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5096 @item @b{examine-fail}
5097 @* After target examine fails.
5098 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5099 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5100 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5101 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5102 connect GDB to running target.
5103 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5104 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5105 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5106 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5107 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5108 is in RAM or read only memory.
5109 Default is @code{halt}
5110 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5111 @* When GDB disconnects
5112 @item @b{gdb-end}
5113 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5114 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5115 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5116 @code{reset init})
5117 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5118 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5119 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5120 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5121 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5122 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5123 @item @b{gdb-start}
5124 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5125 @item @b{halted}
5126 @* The target has halted
5127 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5128 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5129 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5130 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5131 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5132 @item @b{reset-assert}
5133 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5134 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5135 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5136 it instead of asserting SRST.
5137 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5138 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5139 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5140 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5141 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5142 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5143 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5144 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5145 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5146 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5147 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5148 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5149 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5150 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5151 released on the scan chain.
5152 @item @b{reset-end}
5153 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5154 @item @b{reset-init}
5155 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5156 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5157
5158 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5159 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5160 multiplexing, and so on.
5161 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5162 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5163 @item @b{reset-start}
5164 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5165 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5166
5167 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5168 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5169 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5170 @item @b{resume-start}
5171 @* Before any target is resumed
5172 @item @b{resume-end}
5173 @* After all targets have resumed
5174 @item @b{resumed}
5175 @* Target has resumed
5176 @item @b{step-start}
5177 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5178 @item @b{step-end}
5179 @* After single-step has completed
5180 @item @b{trace-config}
5181 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5182 @end itemize
5183
5184 @quotation Note
5185 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5186 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5187 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5188 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5189 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5190 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5191 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5192 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5193 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5194 check if the core has changed status.
5195 @end quotation
5196
5197 @node Flash Commands
5198 @chapter Flash Commands
5199
5200 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5201 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5202 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5203 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5204 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5205 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5206 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5207 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5208 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5209
5210 Flash Steps:
5211 @enumerate
5212 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5213 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5214 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5215 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5216 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5217 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5218 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5219 @item GDB Flashing
5220 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5221 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5222 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5223 @end enumerate
5224
5225 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5226 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5227 so that it can't boot.
5228 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5229 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5230
5231 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5232 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5233 @cindex flash configuration
5234
5235 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5236 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5237 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5238 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5239 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5240 see the driver-specific documentation.
5241
5242 @itemize @bullet
5243 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5244 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5245 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5246 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5247 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5248 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5249 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5250 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5251 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5252 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5253 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5254 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5255 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5256 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5257 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5258 commands to the flash controller.
5259 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5260 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5261 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5262 for more information.
5263 @end itemize
5264 @quotation Note
5265 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5266 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5267 @end quotation
5268 @end deffn
5269
5270 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5271 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5272 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5273 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5274 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5275 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5276 @end deffn
5277
5278 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5279 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5280 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5281 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5282 @end deffn
5283
5284 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5285 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5286 depends on the flash type.
5287 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5288 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5289 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5290 but most don't bother.
5291 @end deffn
5292
5293 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5294
5295 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5296 begins.
5297
5298 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5299 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5300 until the programming session is finished.
5301
5302 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5303 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5304
5305 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5306
5307 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5308 @cindex flash erasing
5309 @cindex flash reading
5310 @cindex flash writing
5311 @cindex flash programming
5312 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5313
5314 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5315 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5316 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5317 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5318 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5319
5320 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5321 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5322 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5323 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5324 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5325
5326 @quotation Note
5327 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5328 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5329 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5330 back to a flash bank.
5331 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5332 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5333 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5334 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5335 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5336 @end quotation
5337
5338 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5339 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5340 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5341 disabled first.
5342 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5343 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5344 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5345
5346 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5347 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5348 up to and including @var{last}.
5349 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5350 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5351 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5352 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5353 @end deffn
5354
5355 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5356 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5357 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5358 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5359 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5360 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5361 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5362 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5363 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5364 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5365 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5366 before erase starts.
5367 @end deffn
5368
5369 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5370 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5371 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5372 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5373 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5374 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5375 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5376 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5377 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5378 before issuing this command.
5379 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5380 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5381 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5382 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5383 @end deffn
5384 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5385
5386 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5387 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5388 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5389 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5390 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5391 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5392 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5393 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5394 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5395 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5396 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5397 @end deffn
5398
5399 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5400 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5401 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5402 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5403 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5404 @end deffn
5405
5406 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5407 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5408 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5409 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5410 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5411 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5412 @end deffn
5413
5414 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5415 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5416 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5417 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5418 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5419 @end deffn
5420
5421 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5422 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5423 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5424 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5425 to the base address for each section in the image.
5426 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5427 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5428 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5429 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5430 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5431 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5432 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5433 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5434 each image section.
5435
5436 @quotation Warning
5437 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5438 data you want to preserve.
5439 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5440 sections might be erased with no notice.
5441 @itemize
5442 @item
5443 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5444 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5445 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5446 @item
5447 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5448 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5449 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5450 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5451 @end itemize
5452 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5453 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5454 @end quotation
5455
5456 @end deffn
5457
5458 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5459 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5460 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5461 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5462 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5463 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5464 ordinary memory reads.
5465 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5466 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5467 check for successful programming.
5468 @end deffn
5469
5470 @section Other Flash commands
5471 @cindex flash protection
5472
5473 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5474 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5475 and display that status.
5476 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5477 @end deffn
5478
5479 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5480 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5481 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5482
5483 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5484 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5485 and possibly stale information.
5486 @end deffn
5487
5488 @anchor{flashprotect}
5489 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5490 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5491 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5492 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5493 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5494 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5495 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5496 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5497 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5498 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5499 @end deffn
5500
5501 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5502 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5503 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5504 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5505 @end deffn
5506
5507 @anchor{program}
5508 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5509 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5510 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5511 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5512 @end deffn
5513
5514 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5515 @section Flash Driver List
5516 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5517 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5518 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5519
5520 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5521 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5522 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5523
5524 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5525
5526 @itemize
5527 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5528 @end itemize
5529
5530 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5531 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5532 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5533 @example
5534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5535 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5536 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5537 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5538 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5539 @end example
5540 @end deffn
5541
5542 @subsection External Flash
5543
5544 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5545 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5546 @cindex CFI
5547 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5548 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5549 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5550 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5551 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5552 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5553 configure a bus and its timings), or
5554 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5555 on the flash chip.
5556 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5557 speed up operation.
5558
5559 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5560
5561 @itemize
5562 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5563 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5564 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5565 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5566 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5567 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5568 @end itemize
5569
5570 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5571 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5572
5573 @example
5574 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5575 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5576 @end example
5577
5578 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5579 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5580 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5581
5582 @example
5583 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5584 @end example
5585
5586 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5590 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5591 @cindex SPI
5592 @cindex jtagspi
5593 @cindex bscan_spi
5594 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5595 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5596 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5597 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5598 accessed through JTAG.
5599
5600 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5601 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5602 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5603 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5604 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5605 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5606
5607 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5608 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5609 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5610 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5611 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5612 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5613 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5614 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5615
5616 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5617 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5618 command, see below.
5619
5620 @itemize
5621 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5622 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5623 @var{USER1} instruction.
5624 @end itemize
5625
5626 @example
5627 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5628 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5629 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5630 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5631 @end example
5632
5633 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5634 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5635 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5636 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5637 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5638 @example
5639 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5640 @end example
5641 @end deffn
5642
5643 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5644 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5645 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5646 @example
5647 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5648 @end example
5649 @end deffn
5650
5651 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5652 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5653 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5654 @end deffn
5655 @end deffn
5656
5657 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5658 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5659 @cindex xcf
5660 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5661 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5662 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5663 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5664 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5665
5666 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5667 command accepts additional parameters:
5668 @itemize
5669 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5670 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5671 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5672 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5673 in master mode.
5674 @end itemize
5675 @example
5676 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5677 @end example
5678 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5679 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5680 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5681 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5682 dedicated sector.
5683 @end deffn
5684
5685 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5686 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5687 button.
5688 @example
5689 xcf configure 0
5690 @end example
5691 @end deffn
5692
5693 Additional driver notes:
5694 @itemize
5695 @item Only single revision supported.
5696 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5697 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5698 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5699 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5700 @end itemize
5701 @end deffn
5702
5703 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5704 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5705 @cindex SPIFI
5706 @cindex lpcspifi
5707 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5708 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5709 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5710
5711 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5712 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5713 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5714 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5715 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5716
5717 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5718 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5719 are configured by the driver.
5720
5721 @example
5722 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5723 @end example
5724
5725 @end deffn
5726
5727 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5728 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5729 @cindex SMI
5730 @cindex stmsmi
5731 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5732 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5733 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5734 SPI flash devices.
5735 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5736 flash devices can be connected.
5737
5738 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5739 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5740 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5741 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5742 the flash content.
5743
5744 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5745 to identify the memory bank.
5746 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5747 flash size, are detected automatically.
5748
5749 @example
5750 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5751 @end example
5752
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5756 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5757 @cindex QuadSPI
5758 @cindex OctoSPI
5759 @cindex stmqspi
5760 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5761 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5762 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5763 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5764 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5765 mode is not.
5766
5767 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5768 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5769 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5770 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5771
5772 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5773 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5774 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5775
5776 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5777 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5778 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5779 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5780 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5781 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5782
5783 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5784 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5785 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5786 should be avoided.
5787
5788 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5789 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5790 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5791 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5792 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5793 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5794
5795 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5796 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5797 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5798 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5799 persist across openocd invocations.
5800
5801 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5802 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5803 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5804 required (see 'set' command).
5805
5806 @example
5807 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5808 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5809 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5810 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5811 @end example
5812
5813 There are three specific commands
5814 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5815 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5816 chip specific write protection engaged.
5817 @end deffn
5818
5819 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5820 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5821 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5822 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5823 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5824 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5825
5826 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5827 which don't support an id command.
5828
5829 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5830 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5831 @end deffn
5832
5833 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5834 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5835 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5836 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5837 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5838
5839 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5840 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5841 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5842 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5843
5844 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5845
5846 To check basic communication settings, issue
5847 @example
5848 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5849 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5850 @end example
5851 for single flash mode or
5852 @example
5853 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5854 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5855 @end example
5856 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5857
5858 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5859 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5860 need a dummy address, e.g.
5861 @example
5862 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5863 @end example
5864 should return the status register contents.
5865
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @end deffn
5869
5870 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5871 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5872 Microcontroller platform.
5873
5874 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5875 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5876
5877 @example
5878 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5879 @end example
5880
5881 @end deffn
5882
5883 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5884 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5885 @cindex ath79
5886 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5887 chip selects.
5888 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5889 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5890 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5891 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5892 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5893 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5894
5895 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5896 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5897 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5898 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5899 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5900 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5901 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5902 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5903 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5904 with the default CS0.
5905 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5906 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5907 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5908
5909 @example
5910 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5911
5912 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5913 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5914 # distinguish the banks.
5915 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5916 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5917 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5918 @end example
5919
5920 @end deffn
5921
5922 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5923 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5924 @cindex fespi
5925
5926 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5927
5928 @example
5929 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5930 @end example
5931 @end deffn
5932
5933 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5934
5935 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5936 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5937 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5938 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5939 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5940 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5941
5942 @example
5943 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5944 @end example
5945 @end deffn
5946
5947 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5948 @cindex ambiqmicro
5949 @cindex apollo
5950 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5951 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5952 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5953 with the target using SWD.
5954
5955 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5956 the device class of the MCU.
5957 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5958 to set up the flash banks.
5959 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5960 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5961
5962 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5963 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5964 and the second bank starts after the first.
5965
5966 @example
5967 # Flash bank 0
5968 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5969 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5970 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5971 $_TARGETNAME
5972 @end example
5973
5974 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5975 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5976 are available to the user.
5977
5978 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5979
5980 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5981 Erase entire bank.
5982 @end deffn
5983 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5984 Erase device pages.
5985 @end deffn
5986 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5987 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5988 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5989 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5990 the flash.
5991 @end deffn
5992 @end deffn
5993
5994 @anchor{at91samd}
5995 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5996 @cindex at91samd
5997 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5998 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5999
6000 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
6001
6002 The devices have one flash bank:
6003
6004 @example
6005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6006 @end example
6007
6008 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
6009 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6010 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6011 processor to be halted.
6012 @end deffn
6013
6014 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
6015 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
6016 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
6017 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
6018 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
6019 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
6020
6021 @example
6022 at91samd set-security enable
6023 @end example
6024 @end deffn
6025
6026 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
6027 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
6028 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
6029 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
6030 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
6031 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
6032 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
6033 in order to disable this feature.
6034
6035 @example
6036 at91samd eeprom
6037 at91samd eeprom 1024
6038 @end example
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6042 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6043 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6044 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6045 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6046 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6047
6048 @example
6049 at91samd bootloader
6050 at91samd bootloader 16384
6051 @end example
6052 @end deffn
6053
6054 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6055 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6056 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6057 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6058 @end deffn
6059
6060 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6061 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6062 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6063 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6064 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6065 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6066 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6067 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6068
6069 @example
6070 # Read user row
6071 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6072 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6073 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6074 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6075 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6076 # byte unchanged
6077 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6078 @end example
6079 @end deffn
6080
6081 @end deffn
6082
6083 @anchor{at91sam3}
6084 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6085 @cindex at91sam3
6086 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6087 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6088 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6089 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6090 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6091 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6092 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6093 chips are confirmed.}
6094
6095 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6096 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6097 the following fixed locations:
6098
6099 @example
6100 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6101 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6102 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6103 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6104 @end example
6105
6106 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6107 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6108 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6109
6110 @itemize
6111 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6112 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6113 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6114 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6115 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6116 @end itemize
6117
6118 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6119
6120 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6121 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6122 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6123 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6124 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6125 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6126 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6127
6128 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6129 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6130 @end deffn
6131
6132 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6133 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6134 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6135 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6136 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6137 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6138 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6139 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6140 @end deffn
6141
6142 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6143 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6144 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6145 @end deffn
6146 @end deffn
6147
6148 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6149 @cindex at91sam4
6150 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6151 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6152 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6153 @end deffn
6154
6155 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6156 @cindex at91sam4l
6157 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6158 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6159 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6160
6161 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6162 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6163 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6164 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6165 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6166 @end deffn
6167 @end deffn
6168
6169 @anchor{atsame5}
6170 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6171 @cindex atsame5
6172 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6173 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6174 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6175
6176 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6177 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6178 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6179
6180 @example
6181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6182 @end example
6183
6184 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6185 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6186 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6187 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6188 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6189 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6190
6191 @example
6192 atsame5 bootloader
6193 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6194 @end example
6195 @end deffn
6196
6197 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6198 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6199 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6200 processor to be halted.
6201 @end deffn
6202
6203 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6204 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6205 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6206 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6207 @end deffn
6208
6209 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6210 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6211 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6212 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6213 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6214 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6215 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6216 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6217
6218 @example
6219 # Read
6220 >atsame5 userpage
6221 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6222 # Write
6223 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6224 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6225 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6226 # bytes)
6227 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6228 @end example
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @end deffn
6232
6233 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6234 @cindex atsamv
6235 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6236 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6237 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6238
6239 @example
6240 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6241 @end example
6242
6243 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6244 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6245 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6246 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6247 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6248
6249 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6250 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @end deffn
6254
6255 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6256 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6257 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6258 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6259 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6260
6261 @example
6262 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6263 @end example
6264
6265 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6266 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6267
6268 @itemize
6269 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6270 @item @var{banks}
6271 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6272 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6273 @item @var{pages_size}
6274 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6275 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6276 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6277 @end itemize
6278
6279 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6280 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6281 will be autoconfigured.
6282 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6283
6284 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6285 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6286 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6287 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6288 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6289
6290 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6291 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6292 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6293 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6294 are not truly general purpose).
6295 @quotation Note
6296 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6297 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6298 @end quotation
6299 @end deffn
6300 @end deffn
6301
6302 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6303 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6304 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6305 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6309 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6310 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6311 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6312
6313 @example
6314 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6315 @end example
6316
6317 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6318 each single sector one by one.
6319
6320 @example
6321 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6322 @end example
6323
6324 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6328 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6329 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6330 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6331 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6332 starts at address 0.
6333
6334 @example
6335 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6336 @end example
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6340 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6341 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6342 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6343 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6344 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6345 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6346 and programming the serial flash.
6347
6348 @example
6349 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6350 @end example
6351 @end deffn
6352
6353 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6354 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6355 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6356 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6357 autoconfigures itself.
6358 @example
6359 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6360 @end example
6361 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6362 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6363 this via the following command:
6364 @example
6365 efm32 debuglock num
6366 @end example
6367 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6368 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6369 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6370 supported.}
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6374 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6375 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6376 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6377 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6378 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6379
6380 @example
6381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6382 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6383 @end example
6384
6385 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6386 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6387 @end deffn
6388
6389 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6390 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6391 is an uncommon operation.}
6392 @end deffn
6393 @end deffn
6394
6395 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6396 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6397 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6398 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6399 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6400 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6401 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6402
6403 @example
6404 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6405 @end example
6406 @end deffn
6407
6408 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6409 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6410 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6411 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6412 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6413 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6414 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6415 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6416 characters) ignored.
6417
6418 @example
6419 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6420 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6421 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6422 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6423 @end example
6424 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6425 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6426 @end deffn
6427
6428 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6429 @cindex kinetis
6430 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6431 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6432 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6433 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6434 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6435 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6436
6437 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6438 @itemize
6439 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6440 @end itemize
6441
6442 @example
6443 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6444 @end example
6445
6446 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6447 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6448 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6449 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6453 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6454 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6455 set by 'flash protect' command.
6456 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6457 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6458 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6459 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6460 with the rest of a flash image.
6461 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6465 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6466 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6470 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6471 and examine-fail event.
6472 @end deffn
6473
6474 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6475 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6476 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6477 @end deffn
6478
6479 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6480 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6481 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6482 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6483 command completes.
6484 @end deffn
6485
6486 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6487 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6488 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6489 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6490 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6491
6492 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6493 Program Partition command.
6494
6495 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6496 Reset the device after partition setting.
6497
6498 Show partition size:
6499 @example
6500 kinetis nvm_partition info
6501 @end example
6502
6503 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6504 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6505 @example
6506 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6507 @end example
6508
6509 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6510 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6511 @example
6512 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6513 @end example
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6517 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6518 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6522 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6523 Command disables watchdog timer.
6524 @end deffn
6525 @end deffn
6526
6527 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6528 @cindex kinetis_ke
6529 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6530 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6531 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6532 autoconfigures itself.
6533 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6534
6535 @example
6536 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6537 @end example
6538
6539 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6540 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6541 @end deffn
6542
6543 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6544 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6545 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6546 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6547 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6548 @end deffn
6549
6550 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6551 Command disables watchdog timer.
6552 @end deffn
6553 @end deffn
6554
6555 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6556 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6557 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6558 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6559 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6560
6561 @quotation Note
6562 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6563 driver:
6564 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6565 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6566 @end quotation
6567
6568 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6569 which must appear in the following order:
6570
6571 @itemize
6572 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6573 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6574 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6575 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6576 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6577 LPC43x[2357])
6578 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6579 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6580 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6581 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6582 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6583 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6584 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6585 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6586 at which the core is running
6587 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6588 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6589 @quotation Note
6590 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6591 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6592 However, if you do provide it,
6593 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6594 @end quotation
6595 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6596 ROM IAP entry point.
6597 @end itemize
6598
6599 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6600
6601 @example
6602 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6603 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6604 @end example
6605
6606 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6607 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6608 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6609 @end deffn
6610 @end deffn
6611
6612 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6613 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6614 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6615 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6616 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6617 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6618
6619 @example
6620 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6621 @end example
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6625 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6626 from NXP.
6627
6628 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6629 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6630 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6631 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6632 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6633 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6634 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6635 you start the PLL.
6636
6637 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6638
6639 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6640 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6641 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6642
6643 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6644 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6645 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6646 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6647 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6648 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6649 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6650
6651 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6652 @example
6653 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6654 @end example
6655
6656 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6657 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6658 @code{flash banks} command.
6659
6660 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6661 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6662 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6663 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6664 a known signature.
6665 Example:
6666 @example
6667 lpc2900 signature 0
6668 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6669 @end example
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6673 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6674 saves it to a file in binary format.
6675 Example:
6676 @example
6677 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6678 @end example
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6682 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6683 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6684 command:
6685
6686 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6687 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6688 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6689 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6690
6691 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6692 Example:
6693 @example
6694 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6695 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6696 @end example
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6700 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6701 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6702 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6703 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6704 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6705 912 bytes.
6706 @quotation Attention
6707 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6708 @end quotation
6709 Example:
6710 @example
6711 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6712 @end example
6713 @end deffn
6714
6715 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6716 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6717 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6718 after the next power cycle.
6719 @quotation Attention
6720 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6721 @end quotation
6722 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6723 Example:
6724 @example
6725 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6726 flash info 0
6727 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6728 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6729 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6730 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6731 @end example
6732 @end deffn
6733
6734 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6735 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6736 effective after the next power cycle.
6737 @quotation Attention
6738 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6739 @end quotation
6740 Examples:
6741 @example
6742 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6743 @end example
6744 @end deffn
6745 @end deffn
6746
6747 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6748 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6749 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6750 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6751
6752 @example
6753 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6754 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6755 @end example
6756
6757 @itemize @bullet
6758 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6759 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6760 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6761 @end itemize
6762
6763 Example usage:
6764 @example
6765 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6766 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6767 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6768 @} else @{
6769 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6770 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6771 @}
6772 @end example
6773 @end deffn
6774
6775 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6776 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6777 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6778 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6779 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6780 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6781
6782 @example
6783 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6784 @end example
6785
6786 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6787 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6788 only the main program flash.
6789
6790 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6791 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6792 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6796 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6797 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6798 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6799
6800 To erase and program the BSL:
6801 @example
6802 msp432 bsl unlock
6803 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6804 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6805 msp432 bsl lock
6806 @end example
6807 @end deffn
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6811 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6812 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6813 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6814 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6815 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6816 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6817 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6818 also have division into regions: main and info.
6819 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6820 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6821
6822 @example
6823 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6824 @end example
6825
6826 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6827
6828 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6829 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6830 @end deffn
6831
6832 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6833 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6837 Erase all userflash including info region.
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6841 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6842 @end deffn
6843
6844 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6845 Check sectors protect.
6846 @end deffn
6847
6848 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6849 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6850 @end deffn
6851
6852 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6853 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6854 @end deffn
6855
6856 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6857 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6858 @end deffn
6859
6860 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6861 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6862 @end deffn
6863
6864 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6865 Show information about flash driver.
6866 @end deffn
6867
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6871 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6872 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6873 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6874 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6875
6876 @example
6877 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6878 @end example
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6882 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6883 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
6884 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
6885 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
6886 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
6887 - ACL).
6888
6889 @example
6890 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6891 @end example
6892
6893 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6894
6895 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6896 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6897 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6898 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6899 code.
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6903 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6904 @end deffn
6905
6906 @end deffn
6907
6908 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6909 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6910 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6911
6912 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6913 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6914 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6915 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6916
6917 @example
6918 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6919 @end example
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6923 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6924 and integrate flash memory.
6925
6926 @example
6927 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6929 @end example
6930
6931 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6932 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6933 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6934 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6935 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6936 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6937 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6938 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6939 @end deffn
6940 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6941 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6942 This will remove any Code Protection.
6943 @end deffn
6944 @end deffn
6945
6946 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6947 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6948 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6949 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6950 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6951
6952 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6953 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6954
6955 @example
6956 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6957 @end example
6958
6959 psoc4-specific commands
6960 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6961 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6962
6963 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6964 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6965
6966 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6967 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6968 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6969
6970 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6974 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6975
6976 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6977 @end deffn
6978 @end deffn
6979
6980 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6981 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6982 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6983 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6984 apart from the base address.
6985
6986 @example
6987 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6988 @end example
6989
6990 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6991 @quotation Attention
6992 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6993 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6994 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6995 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6996 @end quotation
6997
6998 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6999
7000 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
7001 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
7002 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
7003 @end deffn
7004 @end deffn
7005
7006 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
7007 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7008 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7009 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
7010 apart from the base address.
7011
7012 @example
7013 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
7014 $_TARGETNAME
7015 @end example
7016 @end deffn
7017
7018 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
7019 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
7020 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
7021 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
7022
7023 @example
7024 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7025 @end example
7026
7027 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
7028
7029 @itemize
7030 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
7031 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
7032 @end itemize
7033
7034 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
7035
7036 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
7037 @quotation Attention
7038 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
7039 after successful write.
7040 @end quotation
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7044 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7045 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7046 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7047
7048 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7049 @itemize @bullet
7050 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7051 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7052 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7053 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7054 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7055 row size: 512 bytes.
7056 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7057 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7058 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7059 operation will erase row automatically.
7060 @end itemize
7061
7062 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7063 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7064
7065 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7066
7067 @example
7068 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7069 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7070 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7071 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7072 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7073 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7074 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7075 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7076 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7077 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7078 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7079 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7080
7081 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7082 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7083 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7084 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7085 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7086 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7087 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7088 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7089 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7090 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7091 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7092 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7093 @end example
7094
7095 psoc6-specific commands
7096 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7097 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7098 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7099 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7100 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7101 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7105 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7106 by @command{flash banks}.
7107 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7108 @end deffn
7109 @end deffn
7110
7111 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7112 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7113 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7114 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7115 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7116
7117 @example
7118 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7119 @end example
7120 @end deffn
7121
7122 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7123 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7124 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7125 and SWD interface.
7126 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7127 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7128
7129 @example
7130 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7131 @end example
7132
7133 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7134
7135 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7136 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7137 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7138 @end deffn
7139
7140 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7141 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7142 @end deffn
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7146 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7147 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7148 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7149 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7150
7151 @example
7152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7153 @end example
7154
7155 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7156 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7157 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7158 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7159 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7160 disabled.
7161
7162 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7163 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7164 @quotation Warning
7165 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7166 applied to all of them.
7167 @end quotation
7168 @end deffn
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7172 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7173 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7174 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7175 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7176 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7177
7178 @example
7179 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7180 @end example
7181
7182 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7183 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7184 the flash driver.
7185
7186 @example
7187 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7188 @end example
7189
7190 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7191 as per the following example.
7192 @example
7193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7194 @end example
7195
7196 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7197
7198 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7199 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7200 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7204 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7205 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7206 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7207 @end deffn
7208
7209 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7210 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7211 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7215 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7216 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7217 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7221 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7222 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7223 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7227 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7228 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7229 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7230 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7231 @end deffn
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7235 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7236 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7237 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7238 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7239
7240 @example
7241 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7242 @end example
7243
7244 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7245 as per the following example.
7246 @example
7247 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7248 @end example
7249
7250 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7251 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7252 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7253 @end deffn
7254
7255 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7256 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7257 the flash driver.
7258
7259 @example
7260 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7261 @end example
7262
7263 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7264
7265 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7266 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7267 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7271 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7272 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7273 @end deffn
7274
7275 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7276 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7277 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7278 @end deffn
7279
7280 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7281 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7282 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7283 @end deffn
7284
7285 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7286 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7287 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7288 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7289 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7290 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7294 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7295 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7296 @end deffn
7297 @end deffn
7298
7299 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7300 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7301 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7302 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7303 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7304
7305 @example
7306 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7307 @end example
7308
7309 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7310 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7311 the flash driver.
7312
7313 @example
7314 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7315 @end example
7316
7317 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7318
7319 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7320 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7321 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7322 @end deffn
7323
7324 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7325 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7327 @end deffn
7328
7329 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7330 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7331 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7335 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7336 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7337 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7338 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7339
7340 Example usage:
7341 @example
7342 # read OPTSR_CUR
7343 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7344 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7345 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7346 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7347 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7348 @end example
7349 @end deffn
7350
7351 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7352 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7353 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7354 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7355 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7356 will be touched).
7357
7358 Example usage:
7359 @example
7360 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7361 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7362 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7363 @end example
7364 @end deffn
7365 @end deffn
7366
7367 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7368 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7369 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7370 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7371 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7372
7373 @example
7374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7375 @end example
7376
7377 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7378 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7379 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7380 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7381 second bank.
7382
7383 @example
7384 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7385 @end example
7386
7387 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7388
7389 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7390 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7391 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7392 @end deffn
7393
7394 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7395 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7396 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7400 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7401 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7402 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7403 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7404 @end deffn
7405 @end deffn
7406
7407 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7408 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7409 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7410 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7411 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7412 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7413
7414 @example
7415 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7416 @end example
7417
7418 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7419 as per the following example.
7420 @example
7421 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7422 @end example
7423
7424 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7425 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7426 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7430 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7431 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7432 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7433
7434 @example
7435 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7436 @end example
7437
7438 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7439
7440 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7441 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7442 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7443
7444 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7445 @end deffn
7446
7447 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7448 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7449 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7450
7451 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7455 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7456 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7457 @end deffn
7458
7459 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7460 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7461 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7462 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7463
7464 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7465 @example
7466 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7467 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7468 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7469 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7470 @end example
7471
7472 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7473 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7474 @end deffn
7475
7476 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7477 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7478 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7479 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7480 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7481
7482 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7483
7484 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7485 @example
7486 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7487 @end example
7488
7489 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7490 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7491 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7495 List the protected areas using WRP.
7496 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7497 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7498 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7499
7500 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7501 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7502 in single or dual-banks mode.
7503 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7504 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7505
7506 @end deffn
7507
7508 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7509 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7510 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7511 @end deffn
7512
7513 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7514 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7515 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7516 the TrustZone status.
7517 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7518 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7519 @end deffn
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7523 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7524 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7525 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7526 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7527
7528 @example
7529 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7530 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7531 @end example
7532
7533 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7534 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7535 for the specified flash bank.
7536 @end deffn
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7540 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7541 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7542 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7543 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7544
7545 @example
7546 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7547 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7548 @end example
7549
7550 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7551 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7552 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7553
7554 @itemize @bullet
7555 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7556 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7557 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7558 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7559 @end itemize
7560 @end deffn
7561
7562 @end deffn
7563
7564 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7565 @cindex str9xpec
7566
7567 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7568 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7569 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7570 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7571
7572 Here is some background info to help
7573 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7574 the str9:
7575 @enumerate
7576 @item
7577 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7578 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7579 @item
7580 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7581 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7582 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7583 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7584 @end enumerate
7585
7586 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7587 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7588 configured for flash bank 0.
7589 @example
7590 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7591 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7592 adapter assert srst
7593 # turn off target polling
7594 poll off
7595 # disable str9 core
7596 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7597 # read option bytes
7598 str9xpec options_read 0
7599 # re-enable str9 core
7600 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7601 poll on
7602 reset halt
7603 @end example
7604 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7605 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7606 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7607 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7608
7609 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7610
7611 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7612 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7616 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7617 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7618 @end deffn
7619
7620 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7621 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7622 erase the device.
7623 @end deffn
7624
7625 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7626 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7627 @end deffn
7628
7629 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7630 Configure str9 boot bank.
7631 @end deffn
7632
7633 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7634 Configure str9 lvd source.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7638 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7639 @end deffn
7640
7641 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7642 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7643 @end deffn
7644
7645 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7646 Read str9 option bytes.
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7650 Write str9 option bytes.
7651 @end deffn
7652
7653 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7654 unlock str9 device.
7655 @end deffn
7656
7657 @end deffn
7658
7659 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7660 @cindex swm050
7661 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7662
7663 @example
7664 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7665 @end example
7666
7667 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7668
7669 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7670 Erases the entire flash bank.
7671 @end deffn
7672
7673 @end deffn
7674
7675
7676 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7677 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7678 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7679 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7680
7681 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7682
7683 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7684 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7685 @end deffn
7686
7687 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7688 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7689 @end deffn
7690
7691 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7692 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7693 the flash clock.
7694 @end deffn
7695 @end deffn
7696
7697 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7698 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7699 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7700 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7701 correct bank config.
7702
7703 @example
7704 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7705 @end example
7706 @end deffn
7707
7708 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7709 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7710 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7714 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7715 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7716
7717 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7718
7719 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7720 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7721 @end deffn
7722
7723 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7724 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7725 @end deffn
7726
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @section NAND Flash Commands
7730 @cindex NAND
7731
7732 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7733 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7734 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7735
7736 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7737 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7738 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7739 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7740 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7741 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7742
7743 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7744 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7745 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7746 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7747 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7748 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7749 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7750 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7751 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7752 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7753
7754 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7755 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7756 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7757 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7758 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7759 every 512 bytes of data.
7760
7761 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7762 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7763 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7764 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7765 ECC mode is used.
7766
7767 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7768 @enumerate
7769 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7770 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7771 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7772 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7773 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7774 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7775 to access that device.
7776 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7777 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7778 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7779 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7780 de-brick a board.
7781 @end enumerate
7782
7783 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7784 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7785 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7786 are only 32 bits wide.
7787 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7788 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7789 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7790 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7791
7792 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7793 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7794 @cindex NAND configuration
7795
7796 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7797 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7798 OpenOCD has initialized.
7799
7800 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7801 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7802 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7803 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7804 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7805 they were a single (larger) device.
7806 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7807 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7808
7809 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7810 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7811 configuration files, not interactively.
7812
7813 @itemize @bullet
7814 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7815 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7816 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7817 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7818 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7819 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7820 commands to the NAND controller.
7821 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7822 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7823 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7824 for more information.
7825 @end itemize
7826 @end deffn
7827
7828 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7829 Prints a summary of each device declared
7830 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7831 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7832 @example
7833 > nand list
7834 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7835 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7836 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7837 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7838 >
7839 @end example
7840 @end deffn
7841
7842 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7843 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7844 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7845 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7846 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7847 it with most other NAND commands.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7851
7852 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7853 @cindex NAND reading
7854 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7855 starting at the specified offset.
7856 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7857
7858 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7859 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7860
7861 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7862 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7863 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7864
7865 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7866 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7867 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7868 method which handled that error correction.
7869
7870 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7871 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7872 @itemize @bullet
7873 @item no oob_* parameter
7874 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7875 @item @code{oob_raw}
7876 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7877 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7878 spare areas associated with each data page.
7879 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7880 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7881 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7882 @item @code{oob_only}
7883 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7884 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7885 spare areas associated with each data page.
7886 @end itemize
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7890 @cindex NAND erasing
7891 @cindex NAND programming
7892 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7893 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7894 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7895 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7896 If those parameters are not specified,
7897 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7898 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7899
7900 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7901 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7902 block marker.
7903 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7904 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7908 @cindex NAND writing
7909 @cindex NAND programming
7910 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7911 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7912 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7913 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7914
7915 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7916 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7917
7918 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7919 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7920 past the end of the device.
7921 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7922 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7923 if that's being written.)
7924
7925 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7926 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7927 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7928
7929 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7930 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7931 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7932 @itemize @bullet
7933 @item no oob_* parameter
7934 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7935 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7936 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7937 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7938 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7939 @item @code{oob_only}
7940 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7941 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7942 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7943 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7944 @item @code{oob_raw}
7945 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7946 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7947 un-altered OOB.
7948 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7949 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7950 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7951 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7952 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7953 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7954 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7955 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7956 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7957 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7958 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7959 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7960 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7961 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7962 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7963 @end itemize
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7967 @cindex NAND verification
7968 @cindex NAND programming
7969 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7970 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7971 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7972
7973 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7974 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7975
7976 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7977 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7978 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7979 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7980 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7981
7982 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7983 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7984 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7985
7986 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7987 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7988 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7989 be removed in a future release.
7990 @end deffn
7991
7992 @subsection Other NAND commands
7993 @cindex NAND other commands
7994
7995 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7996 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7997 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7998 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7999 continues for @var{length} bytes.
8000 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
8001 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
8002 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8003
8004 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
8005 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
8006 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
8007 @end deffn
8008
8009 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
8010 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8011 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
8012 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
8013 status for each block.
8014 @end deffn
8015
8016 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8017 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
8018 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8019
8020 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
8021 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
8022 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
8023 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
8024 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
8025
8026 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
8027 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
8028 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
8029 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
8030 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
8031 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
8032 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
8036 @subsection NAND Driver List
8037 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
8038 driver-specific options and behaviors.
8039 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
8040
8041 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8042 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8043 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8044 address of the ECC controller.
8045 @example
8046 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8047 @end example
8048 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8049 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8050 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8051 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8052 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8053 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8054 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8055 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8056 @end deffn
8057 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8058 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8059 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8063 properly configured for input or output.
8064 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8065 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8066 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8067 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8068 @end deffn
8069 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8070 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8071 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8072 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8073 @end deffn
8074 @end deffn
8075
8076 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8077 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8078 chips from Texas Instruments.
8079 It takes three extra parameters:
8080 address of the NAND chip;
8081 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8082 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8083 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8084 @example
8085 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8086 @end example
8087 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8088 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8089 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8090 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8091 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8095 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8096 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8097 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8098 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8099 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8100 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8101 @end deffn
8102
8103 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8104 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8105 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8106 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8107 @end deffn
8108 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8109
8110 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8111 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8112 should work for this chip as well.
8113 @end deffn
8114
8115 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8116 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8117 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8118 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8119 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8120 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8121 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8122 @example
8123 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8124 @end example
8125 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8126 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8127 without parameter query status.
8128 @end deffn
8129 @end deffn
8130
8131 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8132 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8133 parameter: the address of the controller.
8134 @example
8135 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8136 @end example
8137 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8138 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8139 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8140 change any behavior.
8141 @end deffn
8142
8143 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8144 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8145 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8146 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8147 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8148 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8149 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8150 specialized commands.
8151 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8152 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8153 change any behavior.
8154 @end deffn
8155
8156 @node Flash Programming
8157 @chapter Flash Programming
8158
8159 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8160 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8161 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8162
8163 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8164 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8165
8166 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8167 @enumerate
8168 @item 'init' is executed.
8169 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8170 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8171 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8172 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8173 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8174 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8175 @end enumerate
8176
8177 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8178
8179 @example
8180 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8181 # are optional parameters
8182 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8183 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8184
8185 # binary files need the flash address passing
8186 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8187 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8188 @end example
8189
8190 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8191 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8192 @cindex PLD
8193 @cindex FPGA
8194
8195 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8196 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8197 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8198 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8199 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8200 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8201 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8202
8203 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8204
8205 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8206 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8207 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8208
8209 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8210 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8211
8212 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8213 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8214 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8215 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8216 behavior.
8217 @end deffn
8218
8219 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8220 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8221 @end deffn
8222
8223 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8224 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8225 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8226 @end deffn
8227
8228 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8229
8230 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8231 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8232 that particular type of PLD.
8233
8234 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8235 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8236 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8237
8238 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8239 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8240 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8241
8242 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8243 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8244 for FPGA @var{num}.
8245 @end deffn
8246 @end deffn
8247
8248 @node General Commands
8249 @chapter General Commands
8250 @cindex commands
8251
8252 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8253 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8254 commands are documented elsewhere.
8255
8256 Intent:
8257 @itemize @bullet
8258 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8259 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8260 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8261 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8262
8263 @item @b{From the human}
8264 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8265 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8266
8267 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8268 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8269 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8270
8271 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8272 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8273 port is 5555.
8274 @end itemize
8275
8276
8277 @section Server Commands
8278
8279 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8280 Exits the current telnet session.
8281 @end deffn
8282
8283 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8284 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8285 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8286 Not every command provides helptext.
8287
8288 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8289 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8290 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8291 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn {Command} {usage} [string]
8295 With no parameters, prints usage text for all commands. Otherwise,
8296 prints all usage text of which command, help text, and usage text
8297 containing @var{string}.
8298 Not every command provides helptext.
8299 @end deffn
8300
8301 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8302 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8303 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8304 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8305 Useful in connection with script files
8306 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8307 @end deffn
8308
8309 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8310 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8311 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8312 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8313
8314 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8315 @example
8316 # redefine shutdown
8317 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8318 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8319 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8320 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8321 original_shutdown
8322 @}
8323 @end example
8324 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8325 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8326 @end deffn
8327
8328 @anchor{debuglevel}
8329 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8330 @cindex message level
8331 Display debug level.
8332 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8333 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8334 Level 0 is error messages only;
8335 level 1 adds warnings;
8336 level 2 adds informational messages;
8337 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8338 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8339 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8340 the command line along with the location of that log
8341 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8342 @xref{Running}.
8343 @end deffn
8344
8345 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8346 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8347 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8348 @example
8349 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8350 @end example
8351 @end deffn
8352
8353 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8354 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8355 the default log output channel is stderr.
8356 @end deffn
8357
8358 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8359 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8360 @end deffn
8361
8362 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8363 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8364 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8365 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8366 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8367 @end deffn
8368
8369 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8370 @section Target State handling
8371 @cindex reset
8372 @cindex halt
8373 @cindex target initialization
8374
8375 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8376 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8377 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8378 a current target which is used to perform the
8379 various operations. The current target may be changed
8380 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8381 target which should become current.
8382
8383 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8384 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8385 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8386 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8387 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8388
8389 @emph{With no arguments}:
8390 list all available registers for the current target,
8391 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8392 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8393 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8394 are flagged as such.
8395
8396 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8397 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8398 bypassing any internal cache.
8399
8400 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8401 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8402 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8403 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8404 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8405 relevant module will flush such values.
8406
8407 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8408 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8409
8410 @example
8411 > reg
8412 ===== ARM registers
8413 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8414 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8415 (2) r2 (/32)
8416 ...
8417 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8418 >
8419 @end example
8420 @end deffn
8421
8422 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8423 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8424 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8425 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8426 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8427 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8428 (and enter debug mode).
8429 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8430
8431 @quotation Warning
8432 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8433 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8434 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8435 power mode by gating the core clock;
8436 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8437
8438 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8439 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8440 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8441 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8442 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8443 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8444
8445 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8446 work with a JTAG debugger.
8447 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8448 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8449 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8450 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8451 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8452 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8453 @end quotation
8454
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8458 Resume the target at its current code position,
8459 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8460 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8464 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8465 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8466 @end deffn
8467
8468 @anchor{resetcommand}
8469 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8470 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8471 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8472 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8473 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8474 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8475 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8476
8477 The optional parameter specifies what should
8478 happen after the reset.
8479 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8480 The other options will not work on all systems.
8481 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8482
8483 @itemize @minus
8484 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8485 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8486 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8487 @end itemize
8488 @end deffn
8489
8490 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8491 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8492 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8493 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8494 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8495 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8496 state.
8497 @end deffn
8498
8499 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8500 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8501 Set values of reset signals.
8502 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8503 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8504 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8505 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8506
8507 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8508 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8509 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8510 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8511 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8512 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8513 the signal will not be modified.
8514
8515 @quotation Note
8516 TRST is specially handled.
8517 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8518 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8519 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8520 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8521 instead of the TRST signal.
8522 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8523 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8524 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8525 with handlers for that event.
8526 @end quotation
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8530 @section Memory access commands
8531 @cindex memory access
8532
8533 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8534 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8535 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8536 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8537
8538 @enumerate
8539 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8540 to change the current target.
8541 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8542 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8543 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8544 @end enumerate
8545
8546 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8547 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8548 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8549 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8550 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8551 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8552 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8553 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8554 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8555 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8556 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8557 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8558 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8559 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8560 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8561 @end deffn
8562
8563 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8564 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8565 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8566 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8567 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8568 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8569 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8570 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8571 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8572 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8573 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8574 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8575 @end deffn
8576
8577 @anchor{imageaccess}
8578 @section Image loading commands
8579 @cindex image loading
8580 @cindex image dumping
8581
8582 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8583 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8584 binary file named @var{filename}.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8588 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8589 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8593 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8594 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8595 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8596 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8597 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8598 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8599 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8600 separately.
8601 @end deffn
8602
8603 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8604 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8605 The file format may optionally be specified
8606 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8607 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8608 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8609 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8610 @example
8611 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8612 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8613 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8614 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8615 $address $length
8616 @}
8617 @end example
8618 @end deffn
8619
8620 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8621 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8622 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8623 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8624 The file format may optionally be specified
8625 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8626 @end deffn
8627
8628 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8629 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8630 The file format may optionally be specified
8631 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8632 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8633 @end deffn
8634
8635 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8636 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8637 The file format may optionally be specified
8638 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8639 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642
8643 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8644 @cindex breakpoint
8645 @cindex watchpoint
8646
8647 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8648 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8649 watchpoints.
8650 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8651
8652 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8653 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8654 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8655 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8656 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8657 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8658
8659 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8660 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8661 @end deffn
8662
8663 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8664 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8665 @end deffn
8666
8667 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8668 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8669 @end deffn
8670
8671 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8672 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8673 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8674 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8675 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8676 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8677 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8678 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8679 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8680 @end deffn
8681
8682
8683 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8684
8685 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8686 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8687 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8688 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8689 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8690 running, can be used.
8691 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8692 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8693 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8694
8695 @quotation Note
8696 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8697 @end quotation
8698
8699 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8700 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8701 communication, respectively.
8702
8703 @quotation Note
8704 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8705 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8706 example.
8707 @end quotation
8708
8709 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8710 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8711 of TCP/IP connections.
8712
8713 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8714 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8715 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8716 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8717 @var{size} bytes.
8718 @end deffn
8719
8720 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8721 Start RTT.
8722 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8723 @end deffn
8724
8725 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8726 Stop RTT.
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8730 Display the polling interval.
8731 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8732 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8733 checked for new data.
8734 @end deffn
8735
8736 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8737 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8738 @end deffn
8739
8740 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8741 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8742 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8743 @end deffn
8744
8745 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8746 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8747 @end deffn
8748
8749 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8750 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8751 @end deffn
8752
8753 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8754 on the target device.
8755
8756 @example
8757 resume
8758
8759 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8760 rtt start
8761
8762 rtt server start 9090 0
8763 @end example
8764
8765 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8766 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8767 TCP/IP port 9090.
8768
8769
8770 @section Misc Commands
8771
8772 @cindex profiling
8773 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8774 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8775 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8776 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8777 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8778 limit the address range.
8779 @end deffn
8780
8781 @deffn {Command} {version}
8782 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8783 @end deffn
8784
8785 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8786 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8787 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @deffn {Command} {add_help_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8791 Add or replace help text on the given @var{command_name}.
8792 @end deffn
8793
8794 @deffn {Command} {add_usage_text} 'command_name' 'help-string'
8795 Add or replace usage text on the given @var{command_name}.
8796 @end deffn
8797
8798 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8799 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8800 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8801 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8802
8803 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8804 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8805 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8806 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8807
8808 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8809 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8810 @cindex tracing
8811 @cindex ETM
8812 @cindex ETB
8813
8814 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8815 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8816 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8817
8818 @itemize
8819 @item
8820 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8821 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8822 supports such an interface.
8823 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8824 and trace port support.)
8825 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8826 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8827 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8828 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8829 in the board-specific configuration file.
8830 @item
8831 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8832 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8833 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8834 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8835 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8836 @end itemize
8837
8838 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8839
8840 @quotation Issues
8841 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8842 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8843
8844 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8845 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8846 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8847 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8848 dummy trace port driver}.
8849
8850 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8851 as well as tracing only during specific states
8852 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8853
8854 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8855 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8856 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8857 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8858 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8859
8860 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8861 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8862 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8863 this original style of JTAG access.
8864 @end quotation
8865
8866 @subsection ETM Configuration
8867 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8868
8869 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8870 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8871 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8872
8873 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8874 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8875 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8876 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8877 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8878 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8879 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8880 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8881 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8882
8883 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8884 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8885 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8886
8887 @quotation Warning
8888 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8889 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8890 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8891 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8892 @end quotation
8893
8894 @quotation Note
8895 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8896 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8897 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8898 what CPU activities are traced.
8899 @end quotation
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8903 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8904 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8905 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8906 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8907 @end deffn
8908
8909 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8910 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8911 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8912 Did trace data overflow?
8913 Was it triggered?
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8917 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8918 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8919 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8920 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8921
8922 @itemize
8923 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8924 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8925 The value is one of
8926 @option{none} (save nothing),
8927 @option{data} (save data),
8928 @option{address} (save addresses),
8929 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8930 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8931 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8932 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8933 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8934 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8935 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8936 trace stream without an image of the code.
8937 @end itemize
8938 @end deffn
8939
8940 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8941 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8942 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8943 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8944 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8945
8946 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8947 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8948 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8949 @end deffn
8950
8951 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8952
8953 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8954 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8955 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8956
8957 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8958 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8959 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8960 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8961 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8962 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8963 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8964
8965 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8966
8967 @itemize
8968 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8969 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8970 for instruction access within that function's body.
8971 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8972 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8973 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8974 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8975 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8976 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8977 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8978 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8979 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8980 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8981 @item @emph{... more}
8982 @end itemize
8983
8984 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8985 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8986
8987 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8988 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8989 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8990 @end deffn
8991
8992 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8993 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8994 @end deffn
8995
8996 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8997 Opens an image file.
8998 @end deffn
8999
9000 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
9001 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
9002 @end deffn
9003
9004 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
9005 Starts trace data collection.
9006 @end deffn
9007
9008 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
9009 Stops trace data collection.
9010 @end deffn
9011
9012 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
9013 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
9014
9015 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
9016
9017 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
9018 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
9019 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
9020 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
9021 any trace data collection.}
9022 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
9023 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
9024 @end deffn
9025 @end deffn
9026
9027 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
9028 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
9029 to use on-chip ETB memory.
9030 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
9031 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
9032 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
9033 @end deffn
9034 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
9035 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
9036 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
9037 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
9038 trace trigger becomes active.
9039
9040 @itemize
9041 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
9042 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
9043 afterwards.
9044 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
9045 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
9046 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
9047 what caused that event to happen.
9048 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
9049 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
9050 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
9051 how the event caused trouble.
9052 @end itemize
9053 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
9054 @end deffn
9055
9056 @end deffn
9057
9058 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9059 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9060 @cindex CTI
9061
9062 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9063 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9064 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9065 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9066 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9067 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9068
9069 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9070 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9071 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9072 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9073 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9074 including additional configuration.
9075 @end deffn
9076
9077 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9078 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9079 @end deffn
9080
9081 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9082 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9083 @end deffn
9084
9085 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9086 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9090 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9091 @end deffn
9092
9093 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9094 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9095 @end deffn
9096
9097 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9098 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9099 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9100 @end deffn
9101
9102 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9103 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9104 of the CTI.
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9108 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9109 useful in TCL scripting.
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @section Generic ARM
9113 @cindex ARM
9114
9115 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9116 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9117 commands that may be available.
9118
9119 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9120 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9121 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9122 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9123 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9124 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9125 @end deffn
9126
9127 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9128 @cindex disassemble
9129 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9130 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9131 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9132 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9133 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9134 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9135 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9136
9137 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9138 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9139 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9140 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9141 with a handful of exceptions.
9142 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9146 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9147 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9148 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9149 and using the MCR instruction.
9150 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9151 an ARM register.)
9152 @end deffn
9153
9154 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9155 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9156 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9157 and the MRC instruction.
9158 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9159 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9160 an ARM register.)
9161 @end deffn
9162
9163 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9164 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9165 core mode if necessary.
9166 @end deffn
9167
9168 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9169 @cindex ARM semihosting
9170 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9171
9172 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9173 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9174 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9175 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9176 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9177 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9178 @end deffn
9179
9180 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9181 @cindex ARM semihosting
9182 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9183
9184 @example
9185 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9186 @end example
9187
9188 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9189 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9190 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9191 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9192 @end deffn
9193
9194 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9195 @cindex ARM semihosting
9196 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9197 status.
9198
9199 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9200 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9201 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9202 debugger.
9203 @end deffn
9204
9205 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9206 @cindex ARM semihosting
9207 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9208
9209 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9210 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9211 the value returned by the target.
9212
9213 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9214 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9215 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9216 encountering a break.
9217
9218 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9219 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9220 to the debugger.
9221 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9222 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9223 request or equivalent").
9224
9225 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9226 this option (default: disabled).
9227 @end deffn
9228
9229 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9230 @cindex ARMv4
9231 @cindex ARMv5
9232
9233 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9234 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9235 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9236 variant.
9237
9238 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9239 @cindex ARM7
9240 @cindex ARM9
9241
9242 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9243 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9244 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9245 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9246
9247 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9248 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9249 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9250 instead of breakpoints.
9251 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9252
9253 This should be
9254 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9255 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9256 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9257 @end deffn
9258
9259 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9260 @cindex DCC
9261 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9262 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9263 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9264
9265 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9266 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9267 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9268 @end deffn
9269
9270 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9271 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9272 that don't check completion of the operation.
9273 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9274
9275 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9276 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9277 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9278 @end deffn
9279
9280 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9281 @cindex ARM9
9282
9283 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9284 integer processors.
9285 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9286
9287 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9288 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9289 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9290 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9291
9292 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9293 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9294 @cindex vector_catch
9295 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9296 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9297 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9298 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9299 to those hardware vectors.
9300
9301 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9302 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9303 vector catch hardware to intercept
9304 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9305 @option{none} of them,
9306 or a list with one or more of the following:
9307 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9308 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9309 @end deffn
9310
9311 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9312 @cindex ARM920T
9313
9314 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9315 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9316 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9317 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9318 and ARM9 commands.
9319
9320 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9321 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9322 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9323 @end deffn
9324
9325 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9326 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9327 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9328 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9329 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9330 (Not all registers can be written.)
9331 @end deffn
9332
9333 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9334 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9335 @end deffn
9336
9337 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9338 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9339 @end deffn
9340
9341 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9342 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9343
9344 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9345 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9346 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9347 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9348 and ARM9 commands.
9349
9350 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9351 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9352
9353 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9354 Print information about the caches found.
9355 @end deffn
9356
9357 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9358 @cindex ARM966E
9359
9360 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9361 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9362 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9363 and ARM9 commands.
9364
9365 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9366 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9367 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9368 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9369 ARM966E-S TRM.
9370 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9371 as required for BIST support.
9372 @end deffn
9373
9374 @subsection XScale specific commands
9375 @cindex XScale
9376
9377 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9378
9379 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9380 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9381 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9382 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9383 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9384 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9385 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9386
9387 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9388 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9389 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9390 the mini-IC.
9391
9392 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9393 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9394 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9395 code layout in memory:
9396 @example
9397 _vectors:
9398 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9399 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9400 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9401 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9402 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9403 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9404 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9405 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9406 .org 0x100
9407 .long real_reset_vector
9408 .long real_ui_handler
9409 .long real_swi_handler
9410 .long real_pf_abort
9411 .long real_data_abort
9412 .long 0 /* unused */
9413 .long real_irq_handler
9414 .long real_fiq_handler
9415 @end example
9416
9417 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9418 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9419 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9420 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9421 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9422 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9423 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9424 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9425 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9426 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9427 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9428 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9429 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9430 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9431 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9432 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9433 software.
9434
9435 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9436 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9437 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9438 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9439
9440 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9441 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9442 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9443 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9444 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9445 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9446 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9447 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9448 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9449
9450 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9451 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9452
9453 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9454 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9455 @end deffn
9456
9457 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9458 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9459 @end deffn
9460
9461 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9462 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9466 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9467 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9471 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9472 @end deffn
9473
9474 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9475 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9476 @end deffn
9477
9478 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9479 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9480 @end deffn
9481
9482 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9483 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9484 @end deffn
9485
9486 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9487 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9491 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9492 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9493 and modifying how it is emptied.
9494 @end deffn
9495
9496 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9497 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9498 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9499 The image @var{type} may be one of
9500 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9501 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9502 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9506 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9507 @cindex vector_catch
9508 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9509 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9510
9511 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9512 @example
9513 0x01 Trap Reset
9514 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9515 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9516 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9517 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9518 0x20 reserved
9519 0x40 Trap IRQ
9520 0x80 Trap FIQ
9521 @end example
9522 @end deffn
9523
9524 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9525 @cindex vector_table
9526
9527 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9528 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9529 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9530 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9531 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9532
9533 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9534
9535 @end deffn
9536
9537 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9538 @cindex ARMv6
9539
9540 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9541 @cindex ARM11
9542
9543 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9544 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9545 which is enabled by default.
9546 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9547 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9548 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9549 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9550 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9551 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9552 @end deffn
9553
9554 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9555 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9556 which is enabled by default.
9557 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9558 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9559 @end deffn
9560
9561 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9562 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9563 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9564 they are disabled by default.
9565 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9566 @end deffn
9567
9568 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9569 @cindex vector_catch
9570 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9571 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9572 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9573
9574 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9575 for certain hardware events.
9576 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9577 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9578 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9579 @end deffn
9580
9581 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9582 @cindex ARMv7
9583 @cindex ARMv8
9584
9585 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9586 @cindex Cortex-A
9587
9588 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9589 display information about target caches
9590 @end deffn
9591
9592 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9593 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9594 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9595 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9596 Defaults to 'off'.
9597 @end deffn
9598
9599 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9600 Initialize core debug
9601 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9602 @end deffn
9603
9604 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9605 Display/set the current SMP mode
9606 @end deffn
9607
9608 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9609 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9610 @end deffn
9611
9612 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9613 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9614 @end deffn
9615
9616 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9617 configure l2x cache
9618 @end deffn
9619
9620 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9621 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9622 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9623 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9624 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9625 @end deffn
9626
9627 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9628 @cindex Cortex-R
9629
9630 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9631 Initialize core debug
9632 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9633 @end deffn
9634
9635 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9636 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9637 @end deffn
9638
9639
9640 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9641 @cindex tracing
9642 @cindex SWO
9643 @cindex SWV
9644 @cindex TPIU
9645
9646 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9647 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9648 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9649 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9650
9651 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9652 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9653 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9654 which causes quite some confusion.
9655 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9656 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9657
9658 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9659 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9660 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9661
9662 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9663 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9664 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9665 @end deffn
9666
9667 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9668 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9669 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9670 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9671
9672 @itemize @bullet
9673 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9674 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9675 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9676 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9677
9678 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9679 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9680 @end itemize
9681 @end deffn
9682
9683 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9684 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9685 @end deffn
9686
9687 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9688 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9689 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9690 at any time after the initialization, too.
9691 @end deffn
9692
9693 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9694 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9695 individually queried, to return its current value.
9696 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9697 @end deffn
9698
9699 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9700 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9701 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9702 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9703
9704 @itemize @bullet
9705 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9706 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9707
9708 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9709 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9710
9711 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9712 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9713
9714 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9715 protocol used for trace data:
9716 @itemize @minus
9717 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9718 data bits (default);
9719 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9720 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9721 @end itemize
9722
9723 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9724 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9725 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9726 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9727 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9728 of the TPIU.
9729
9730 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9731 the destination of the trace data:
9732 @itemize @minus
9733 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9734 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9735 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9736 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9737 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9738 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9739 each connected client;
9740 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9741 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9742 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9743 @end itemize
9744
9745 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9746 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9747 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9748 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9749
9750 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9751 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9752 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9753 maximum supported rate automatically.
9754
9755 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9756 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9757 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9758
9759 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9760 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9761 default value is @var{0}.
9762 @end itemize
9763 @end deffn
9764
9765 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9766 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9767 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9768 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9769 data.
9770 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9771 after the @command{init}.
9772 @end deffn
9773
9774 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9775 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9776 @end deffn
9777
9778
9779
9780 Example usage:
9781 @enumerate
9782 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9783 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9784 enough to:
9785 @example
9786 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9787 ...
9788 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9789 ...
9790 @end example
9791 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9792 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9793 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9794 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9795 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9796 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9797 @example
9798 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9799 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9800 @end example
9801 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9802 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9803 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9804 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9805 @example
9806 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9807 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9808 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9809 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9810 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9811 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9812 @end example
9813 @end enumerate
9814
9815 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9816 @cindex tracing
9817 @cindex SWO
9818 @cindex SWV
9819 @cindex ITM
9820 @cindex ETM
9821
9822 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9823 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9824 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9825 @end deffn
9826
9827 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9828 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9829 @end deffn
9830
9831 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9832 @cindex Cortex-M
9833
9834 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9835 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9836
9837 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9838 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9839 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9840 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9841 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9842 the step command leaves with the core running.
9843
9844 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9845 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9846 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9847 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9848
9849 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9850 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9851 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9852 does.
9853
9854 Default is @option{auto}.
9855 @end deffn
9856
9857 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9858 @cindex vector_catch
9859 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9860 for certain hardware events.
9861
9862 Parameters request interception of
9863 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9864 @option{none} of them,
9865 or one or more of the following:
9866 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9867 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9868 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9869 @option{irq_err},
9870 @option{state_err},
9871 @option{chk_err}, or
9872 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9873 @option{reset}.
9874 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9875 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9876 are mapped to HardFault.
9877 UsageFault checks for
9878 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9879 must also be explicitly enabled.
9880
9881 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9882 @end deffn
9883
9884 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9885 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9886 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9887
9888 @itemize @minus
9889 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9890 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9891 @end itemize
9892
9893 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9894 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9895 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9896 to manually reset the peripherals.
9897 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9898
9899 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9900 instead.
9901 @end deffn
9902
9903 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9904 @cindex ARMv8-A
9905 @cindex aarch64
9906
9907 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9908 Display information about target caches
9909 @end deffn
9910
9911 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9912 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9913 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9914 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9915 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9916 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9917 @end deffn
9918
9919 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9920 @cindex disassemble
9921 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9922 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9923 @end deffn
9924
9925 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9926 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9927 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9928 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9929 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9930 @end deffn
9931
9932 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9933 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9934 @option{on}.
9935 @end deffn
9936
9937 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9938 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9939 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9940 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9941 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9942 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9943 @end deffn
9944
9945 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9946
9947 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9948 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9949
9950 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9951
9952 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9953 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9954 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9955 @end deffn
9956
9957 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9958 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9959 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9960 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9961 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9962 @end deffn
9963
9964 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9965
9966 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9967 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9968 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9969 @end deffn
9970
9971 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9972
9973 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9974 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9975 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9976 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9977 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9978 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9979 can be collected.
9980
9981 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9982 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9983 tooling.
9984
9985 @quotation Issues
9986 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9987 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9988 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9989 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9990
9991 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9992 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9993 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9994 software operation on the CPU.
9995 @end quotation
9996
9997 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9998 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9999 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
10000 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
10001 @end deffn
10002
10003 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
10004 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
10005 @end deffn
10006
10007 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10008 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
10009 control is disabled.
10010 @end deffn
10011
10012 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
10013 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
10014 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
10015 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
10016
10017 Supported trace formats:
10018 @itemize
10019 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
10020 timing to be determined.
10021 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
10022 addresses.
10023 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
10024 @end itemize
10025 @end deffn
10026
10027 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
10028 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
10029 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
10030 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10031
10032 Supported conditions:
10033 @itemize
10034 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
10035 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
10036 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
10037 instruction matches start data and mask.
10038 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
10039 instruction matches start data and mask.
10040 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
10041 data and mask.
10042 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10043 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10044 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10045 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
10046 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
10047 @end itemize
10048 @end deffn
10049
10050 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
10051 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
10052 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
10053 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
10054
10055 Supported conditions:
10056 @itemize
10057 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10058 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10059 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10060 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10061 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10062 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10063 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10064 data and mask.
10065 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10066 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10067 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10068 @end itemize
10069 @end deffn
10070
10071 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10072 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10073
10074 Supported triggers:
10075 @itemize
10076 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10077 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10078 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10079 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10080 collection.
10081 @end itemize
10082 @end deffn
10083
10084 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10085
10086 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10087 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10088 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10089 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10090 @end deffn
10091
10092 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10093 Display trace configuration.
10094 @end deffn
10095
10096 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10097 Display trace collection status.
10098 @end deffn
10099
10100 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10101 Start manual trace collection.
10102 @end deffn
10103
10104 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10105 Stop manual trace collection.
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10109 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10110 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10111 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10112 @option{size} options using DMA.
10113 @end deffn
10114
10115 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10116 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10117 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10118 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10119 @option{size} options using DMA.
10120 @end deffn
10121
10122 @section Intel Architecture
10123
10124 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10125 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10126 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10127 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10128 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10129 @itemize
10130 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10131 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10132 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10133 @end itemize
10134
10135 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10136 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10137 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10138
10139 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10140 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10141 @end deffn
10142
10143 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10144 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10145 @end deffn
10146
10147 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10148 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10149 @end deffn
10150
10151 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10152 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10153 @end deffn
10154
10155 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10156 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10157 @end deffn
10158
10159 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10160 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10161 @end deffn
10162
10163 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10164
10165 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10166 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10167
10168 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10169 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10170 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10171 @end deffn
10172 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10173 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10174
10175 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10176
10177 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10178 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10179 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10180 @end deffn
10181
10182 @subsection Registers commands
10183 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10184 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10185 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10186
10187 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10188
10189 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10190 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10191 and "timer" groups.
10192
10193 @emph{example:}
10194 @example
10195 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10196 @end example
10197
10198 @end deffn
10199
10200 @section RISC-V Architecture
10201
10202 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10203 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10204 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10205 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10206 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10207 implement version 0.11.
10208
10209 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10210
10211 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10212 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10213 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10214
10215 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10216
10217 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n[-m|=name] [...]
10218 Configure which CSRs to expose in addition to the standard ones. The CSRs to expose
10219 can be specified as individual register numbers or register ranges (inclusive). For the
10220 individually listed CSRs, a human-readable name can optionally be set using the @code{n=name}
10221 syntax, which will get @code{csr_} prepended to it. If no name is provided, the register will be
10222 named @code{csr<n>}.
10223
10224 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10225 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10226 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or if the target implements custom
10227 CSRs.
10228
10229 @example
10230 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 128 under the name "csr128":
10231 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128
10232
10233 # Expose multiple RISC-V CSRs 128..132 under names "csr128" through "csr132":
10234 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 128-132
10235
10236 # Expose a single RISC-V CSR number 1996 under custom name "csr_myregister":
10237 $_TARGETNAME expose_csrs 1996=myregister
10238 @end example
10239 @end deffn
10240
10241 @deffn {Config Command} {riscv expose_custom} n[-m|=name] [...]
10242 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10243 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10244 configures individual registers or register ranges (inclusive) that shall be exposed.
10245 Number 0 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10246 For individually listed registers, a human-readable name can be optionally provided
10247 using the @code{n=name} syntax, which will get @code{custom_} prepended to it. If no
10248 name is provided, the register will be named @code{custom<n>}.
10249
10250 @example
10251 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc010 (0xc000 + 16)
10252 # under the name "custom16":
10253 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16
10254
10255 # Expose a range of RISC-V custom registers with numbers 0xc010 .. 0xc018
10256 # (0xc000+16 .. 0xc000+24) under the names "custom16" through "custom24":
10257 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 16-24
10258
10259 # Expose one RISC-V custom register with number 0xc020 (0xc000 + 32) under
10260 # user-defined name "custom_myregister":
10261 $_TARGETNAME expose_custom 32=myregister
10262 @end example
10263 @end deffn
10264
10265 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10266 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10267 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10268 @end deffn
10269
10270 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10271 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10272 deasserted.
10273 @end deffn
10274
10275 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10276 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10277 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10278 @end deffn
10279
10280 @deffn Command {riscv set_mem_access} method1 [method2] [method3]
10281 Specify which RISC-V memory access method(s) shall be used, and in which order
10282 of priority. At least one method must be specified.
10283
10284 Available methods are:
10285 @itemize
10286 @item @code{progbuf} - Use RISC-V Debug Program Buffer to access memory.
10287 @item @code{sysbus} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug System Bus interface.
10288 @item @code{abstract} - Access memory via RISC-V Debug abstract commands.
10289 @end itemize
10290
10291 By default, all memory access methods are enabled in the following order:
10292 @code{progbuf sysbus abstract}.
10293
10294 This command can be used to change the memory access methods if the default
10295 behavior is not suitable for a particular target.
10296 @end deffn
10297
10298 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10299 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10300 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10301 on physical memory.
10302 @end deffn
10303
10304 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10305 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10306 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10307 performed on physical memory.
10308 @end deffn
10309
10310 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10311 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10312 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10313 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10314 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10315 race condition problem in your code.
10316
10317 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10318 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10319 @end deffn
10320
10321 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10322 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10323 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10324 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10325 values.
10326
10327 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10328 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10329 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10330 @end deffn
10331
10332 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10333 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10334 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10335 @end deffn
10336
10337 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10338 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10339 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10340 @end deffn
10341
10342 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10343 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10344 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10345 @end deffn
10346
10347 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10348 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10349 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10350 @end deffn
10351
10352 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10353
10354 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10355 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10356 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10357 @example
10358 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10359 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10360 @end example
10361
10362 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10363 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10367 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10368 @end deffn
10369
10370 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10371
10372 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10373 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10374
10375 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10376 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10380 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10381 @end deffn
10382
10383 @section ARC Architecture
10384 @cindex ARC
10385
10386 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10387 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10388 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10389 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10390 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10391 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10392 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10393 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10394 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10395 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10396 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10397 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10398 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10399 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10400 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10401
10402
10403 @subsection General ARC commands
10404
10405 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10406
10407 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10408 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10409 arguments:
10410
10411 @itemize @bullet
10412
10413 @item @code{-name} name
10414 @*Name of a register.
10415
10416 @item @code{-num} number
10417 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10418
10419 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10420 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10421
10422 @end itemize
10423
10424 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10425
10426 @itemize @bullet
10427
10428 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10429 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10430 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10431 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10432 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10433 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10434
10435 @item @code{-core}
10436 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10437 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10438 spaces.
10439
10440 @item @code{-bcr}
10441 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10442 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10443 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10444 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10445 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10446
10447 @item @code{-type} type_name
10448 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10449 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10450
10451 @item @code{-g}
10452 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10453 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10454 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10455 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10456 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10457
10458 @end itemize
10459
10460 @end deffn
10461
10462 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10463 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10464 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10465 @end deffn
10466
10467 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10468 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10469 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10470 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10471 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10472 startbit endbit}.
10473 @end deffn
10474
10475 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10476 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10477 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10478 @end deffn
10479
10480 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10481 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10482 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10483 @end deffn
10484
10485 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10486
10487 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10488 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10489 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10490 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10491
10492 @end deffn
10493
10494 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10495 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10496 registers.
10497 @end deffn
10498
10499 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10500 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10501 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10502 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10503
10504 @end deffn
10505
10506 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10507 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10508 registers.
10509 @end deffn
10510
10511 @section STM8 Architecture
10512 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10513 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10514
10515 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10516 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10517
10518 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10519 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10520 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10521 @cindex tracing
10522 @cindex libdcc
10523 @cindex DCC
10524 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10525 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10526 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10527 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10528
10529 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10530 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10531 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10532 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10533 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10534 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10535
10536 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10537 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10538 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10539 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10540 The target being debugged may
10541 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10542 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10543 each supported by a command:
10544
10545 @itemize
10546 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10547 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10548 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10549 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10550
10551 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10552 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10553 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10554
10555 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10556 and then displayed at any time.
10557 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10558
10559 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10560 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10561 @end itemize
10562
10563 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10564 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10565 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10566 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10567 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10568 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10569 does the same thing.
10570
10571 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10572 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10573 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10574 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10575 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10576
10577 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10578 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10579 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10580 @end deffn
10581
10582 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10583 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10584 in the order they triggered.
10585 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10586 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10587 history records.
10588 @end deffn
10589
10590 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10591 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10592 they have been triggered.
10593 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10594 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10595 and associates it with that identifier.
10596
10597 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10598 are not related except by this command.
10599 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10600 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10601 @end deffn
10602
10603
10604 @node JTAG Commands
10605 @chapter JTAG Commands
10606 @cindex JTAG Commands
10607 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10608 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10609 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10610 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10611 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10612
10613 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10614 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10615
10616 @itemize @bullet
10617 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10618 devices such as a CPUs.
10619 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10620 standard state machine (in parallel)
10621 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10622 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10623 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10624 while the reading previous ones.
10625 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10626 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10627 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10628 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10629 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10630 registers.
10631 @end itemize
10632
10633 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10634
10635 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10636 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10637 the order of TAP state transitions.
10638 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10639 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10640 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10641 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10642 these commands are not available.
10643
10644 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10645 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10646 that specify the entire register.
10647 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10648 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10649 The return value holds the original value of each
10650 of those fields.
10651
10652 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10653 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10654 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10655 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10656 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10657
10658 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10659 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10660
10661 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10662 in that state.
10663 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10664 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10665 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10666
10667 @quotation Warning
10668 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10669 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10670 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10671 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10672 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10673 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10674 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10675 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10676 @end quotation
10677 @end deffn
10678
10679 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10680 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10681 This may be used for performance tuning.
10682
10683 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10684 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10685 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10686 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10687 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10688 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10689 @end deffn
10690
10691 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10692 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10693 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10694 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10695 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10696 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10697
10698 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10699 in that state.
10700 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10701 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10702 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10703
10704 @quotation Note
10705 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10706 register values, unlike data register values.
10707 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10708 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10709 @end quotation
10710 @end deffn
10711
10712 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10713 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10714 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10715 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10716 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10717 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10718 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10719 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10720 The final state must also be stable.
10721 @end deffn
10722
10723 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10724 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10725 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10726 Instructions often need some time
10727 to execute before they take effect.
10728 @end deffn
10729
10730 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10731 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10732
10733 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10734 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10735 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10736 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10737 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10738 @end deffn
10739
10740 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10741 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10742 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10743 must also be enabled.
10744 Default is enabled.
10745 @end deffn
10746
10747 @section TAP state names
10748 @cindex TAP state names
10749
10750 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10751 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10752 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10753 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10754
10755 @itemize @bullet
10756 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10757 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10758 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10759 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10760 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10761 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10762 through the data register
10763 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10764 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10765 for update or more shifting
10766 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10767 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10768 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10769 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10770 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10771 through the instruction register
10772 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10773 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10774 for update or more shifting
10775 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10776 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10777 @end itemize
10778
10779 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10780 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10781 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10782 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10783
10784 @itemize @bullet
10785 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10786 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10787 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10788 may not be as expected.
10789 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10790 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10791 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10792 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10793 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10794 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10795 @end itemize
10796
10797 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10798 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10799
10800 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10801 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10802 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10803 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10804
10805 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10806 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10807 @cindex SVF
10808
10809 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10810 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10811 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10812 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10813
10814 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10815 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10816 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10817 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10818
10819 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10820 affect their semantics.
10821
10822 Command options:
10823 @itemize @minus
10824 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10825 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10826 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10827 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10828 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10829 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10830 on the real interface;
10831 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10832 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10833 errors.
10834 @end itemize
10835 @end deffn
10836
10837 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10838 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10839 @cindex XSVF
10840
10841 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10842 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10843 Xilinx devices.
10844 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10845 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10846
10847 @quotation Important
10848 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10849 @end quotation
10850
10851 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10852 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10853 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10854 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10855 that TAP.
10856 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10857 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10858 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10859 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10860 @end deffn
10861
10862 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10863 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10864 after building the software.
10865 You may find them useful:
10866
10867 @itemize
10868 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10869 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10870 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10871 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10872 @end itemize
10873
10874 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10875 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10876 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10877 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10878 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10879 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10880 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10881
10882
10883 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10884 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10885 @cindex IPDBG
10886
10887 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10888 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10889 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10890 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10891 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10892 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10893
10894 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10895 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10896
10897 Command options:
10898 @itemize @bullet
10899 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10900 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10901 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10902 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10903 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10904 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10905 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10906 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10907 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10908 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10909 shift data through vir can be configured.
10910 @end itemize
10911 @end deffn
10912
10913 Examples:
10914 @example
10915 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10916 @end example
10917 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10918 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10919
10920 @example
10921 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10922 @end example
10923 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10924 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10925
10926 @node Utility Commands
10927 @chapter Utility Commands
10928 @cindex Utility Commands
10929
10930 @section RAM testing
10931 @cindex RAM testing
10932
10933 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10934 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10935 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10936 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10937 hardware problems.
10938
10939 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10940 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10941 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10942 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10943
10944 Load the memory testing functions with
10945
10946 @example
10947 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10948 @end example
10949
10950 to get access to the following facilities:
10951
10952 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10953 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10954 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10955 @end deffn
10956
10957 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10958 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10959 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10960 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10961 @end deffn
10962
10963 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10964 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10965 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10966 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10967 @end deffn
10968
10969 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10970 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10971 @end deffn
10972
10973 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10974 @cindex Firmware recovery
10975
10976 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10977 devices recovery with JTAG.
10978
10979 For quickstart instructions run:
10980 @example
10981 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10982 @end example
10983
10984 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10985 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10986 @cindex GDB
10987 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10988 to debug remote targets.
10989 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10990
10991 @itemize
10992 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10993 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10994 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10995 as shown in this chapter.
10996 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10997 that also will probably need to be configured.
10998 @end itemize
10999
11000 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
11001 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
11002 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
11003 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
11004 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
11005 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
11006
11007 @section Connecting to GDB
11008 @cindex Connecting to GDB
11009 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
11010 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
11011 errors, which has since been fixed; see
11012 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
11013
11014 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
11015
11016 @enumerate
11017 @item
11018 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
11019 @example
11020 target extended-remote localhost:3333
11021 @end example
11022 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
11023
11024 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
11025 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
11026 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
11027
11028 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
11029 remote command above that becomes:
11030 @example
11031 tar ext :3333
11032 @end example
11033
11034 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
11035 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
11036 available through the command:
11037 @example
11038 target remote localhost:3333
11039 @end example
11040
11041 @item
11042 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
11043 @example
11044 target extended-remote | \
11045 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
11046 @end example
11047 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
11048 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
11049 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
11050 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
11051 @end enumerate
11052
11053 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
11054 GDB command line.
11055
11056 @section Sample GDB session startup
11057
11058 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
11059 than they do when you're debugging locally.
11060 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
11061 small ARM program.
11062 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
11063 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
11064
11065 @example
11066 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
11067 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
11068 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
11069 ...
11070 (gdb) monitor reset halt
11071 ...
11072 (gdb) load
11073 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
11074 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
11075 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
11076 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
11077 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
11078 (gdb) continue
11079 Continuing.
11080 ...
11081 @end example
11082
11083 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
11084 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
11085 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
11086 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
11087
11088 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
11089
11090 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
11091 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
11092 packet size and the device's memory map.
11093 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
11094 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
11095 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
11096
11097 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
11098 You may need to set those up by hand.
11099 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
11100 something like:
11101
11102 @example
11103 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11104 @end example
11105
11106 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11107
11108 @example
11109 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11110 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11111 @end example
11112
11113 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11114 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11115 do not have such restrictions.
11116
11117 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11118 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11119 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11120 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11121
11122 @section Programming using GDB
11123 @cindex Programming using GDB
11124 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11125
11126 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11127 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11128 @example
11129 gdb_memory_map disable
11130 @end example
11131 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11132 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11133 working area.
11134
11135 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11136 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11137 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11138 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11139
11140 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11141 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11142
11143 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11144 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11145 @example
11146 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11147 @end example
11148
11149 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11150 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11151
11152 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11153 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11154 will be used.
11155
11156 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11157 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11158 @example
11159 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11160 @end example
11161 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11162
11163 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11164 can be used.
11165
11166 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11167 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11168 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11169
11170 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11171 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11172 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11173
11174 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11175 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11176 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11177 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11178 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11179 without any intrusion of the target process.
11180
11181 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11182 Place following command after target configuration:
11183 @example
11184 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11185 @end example
11186
11187 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11188 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11189 @example
11190 gdb_memory_map disable
11191 @end example
11192
11193 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11194 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11195 @example
11196 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11197 @end example
11198
11199 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11200 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11201
11202 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11203 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11204 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11205 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11206
11207 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11208 previously shown variables.
11209
11210 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11211 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11212 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11213 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11214 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11215
11216 @section RTOS Support
11217 @cindex RTOS Support
11218 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11219
11220 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11221 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11222
11223 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11224 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11225 GDB commands.
11226
11227 @* An example setup is below:
11228
11229 @example
11230 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11231 @end example
11232
11233 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11234
11235 Currently supported rtos's include:
11236 @itemize @bullet
11237 @item @option{eCos}
11238 @item @option{ThreadX}
11239 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11240 @item @option{linux}
11241 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11242 @item @option{embKernel}
11243 @item @option{mqx}
11244 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11245 @item @option{nuttx}
11246 @item @option{RIOT}
11247 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11248 @item @option{Zephyr}
11249 @end itemize
11250
11251 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11252 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11253
11254 @table @code
11255 @item eCos symbols
11256 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11257 @item ThreadX symbols
11258 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11259 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11260 @raggedright
11261 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11262 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11263 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11264 @end raggedright
11265 @item linux symbols
11266 init_task.
11267 @item ChibiOS symbols
11268 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11269 @item embKernel symbols
11270 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11271 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11272 @item mqx symbols
11273 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11274 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11275 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11276 @item nuttx symbols
11277 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11278 @item RIOT symbols
11279 @raggedright
11280 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11281 _tcb_name_offset.
11282 @end raggedright
11283 @item Zephyr symbols
11284 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11285 @end table
11286
11287 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11288 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11289
11290 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11291 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11292
11293 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11294 along with the project:
11295
11296 @table @code
11297 @item FreeRTOS
11298 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11299 @item uC/OS-III
11300 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11301 @end table
11302
11303 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11304 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11305 @cindex SMP
11306 @cindex RTOS
11307 @cindex hwthread
11308 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11309 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11310 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11311 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11312 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11313 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11314 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11315 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11316 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11317
11318 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11319 @quotation Note
11320 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11321 @end quotation
11322
11323 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11324 @itemize @bullet
11325 @item j - smp status request
11326 @item J - smp set request
11327 @end itemize
11328
11329 OpenOCD implements :
11330 @itemize @bullet
11331 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11332 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11333 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11334 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11335 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11336 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11337 @end itemize
11338
11339 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11340 @itemize @bullet
11341 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11342 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11343 @example
11344 set $_core 1
11345 #Jc01 packet is sent
11346 print $_core
11347 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11348 @end example
11349
11350 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11351 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11352
11353 @example
11354 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11355 define toggle0
11356 maint packet Jc0
11357 continue
11358 main packet Jc-1
11359 end
11360 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11361 define toggle1
11362 maint packet Jc1
11363 continue
11364 main packet Jc-1
11365 end
11366 @end example
11367 @end itemize
11368
11369 @node Tcl Scripting API
11370 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11371 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11372 @cindex Tcl scripts
11373 @section API rules
11374
11375 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11376 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11377 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11378
11379 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11380 pair list and lists.
11381
11382 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11383 list.
11384
11385 @example
11386 > set foo(me) Duane
11387 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11388 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11389 > set foo(duck) Donald
11390 @end example
11391
11392 If one does this:
11393
11394 @example
11395 > set foo
11396 @end example
11397
11398 The result is:
11399
11400 @example
11401 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11402 @end example
11403
11404 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11405
11406 @verbatim
11407 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11408 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11409 }
11410 @end verbatim
11411
11412 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11413 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11414
11415 @section Internal low-level Commands
11416
11417 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11418 invoke directly.
11419
11420 @itemize @bullet
11421 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11422
11423 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11424 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11425
11426 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11427 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11428
11429 Return information about the flash banks
11430
11431 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11432
11433 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11434 its execution. Example:
11435
11436 @example
11437 > capture "reset init"
11438 @end example
11439
11440 @end itemize
11441
11442 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11443 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11444 called "flash_banks".
11445
11446 @section Tcl RPC server
11447 @cindex RPC
11448
11449 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11450 commands and receive the results.
11451
11452 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11453 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11454 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11455 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11456 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11457
11458 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11459 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11460 @command{capture} command.
11461
11462 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11463
11464 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11465 @cindex RPC Notifications
11466
11467 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11468 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11469
11470 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11471 in the following format.
11472
11473 @verbatim
11474 type target_event event [event-name]
11475 type target_state state [state-name]
11476 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11477 @end verbatim
11478
11479 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11480 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11481 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11482 Defaults to off.
11483
11484 @end deffn
11485
11486 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11487 @cindex RPC trace output
11488
11489 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11490 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11491
11492 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11493
11494 @verbatim
11495 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11496 @end verbatim
11497
11498 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11499 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11500 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11501 Defaults to off.
11502
11503 See an example application here:
11504 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11505
11506 @end deffn
11507
11508 @node FAQ
11509 @chapter FAQ
11510 @cindex faq
11511 @enumerate
11512 @anchor{faqrtck}
11513 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11514 @cindex RTCK
11515 @cindex adaptive clocking
11516 @*
11517
11518 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11519 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11520 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11521 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11522
11523 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11524 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11525 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11526 @enumerate
11527 @item
11528 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11529 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11530 @item
11531 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11532 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11533 @end enumerate
11534
11535 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11536 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11537 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11538 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11539 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11540 power).
11541
11542 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11543 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11544 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11545 ARM926 scenario).
11546 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11547 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11548 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11549
11550 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11551 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11552 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11553 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11554
11555 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11556
11557 In order to make use of this,
11558 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11559 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11560
11561 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11562 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11563 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11564 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11565 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11566
11567 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11568 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11569 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11570 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11571
11572 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11573 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11574 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11575 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11576 with a CPLD.
11577 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11578 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11579 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11580 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11581 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11582 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11583
11584 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11585
11586 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11587
11588 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11589 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11590 depending on the chips on your board.
11591 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11592 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11593 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11594
11595 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11596 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11597 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11598
11599 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11600 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11601 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11602 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11603
11604 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11605 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11606 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11607 this way.
11608
11609 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11610 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11611 clock rate.
11612 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11613 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11614 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11615
11616 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11617
11618 @example
11619 # Example: 1.234MHz
11620 adapter speed 1234
11621 @end example
11622
11623
11624 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11625
11626 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11627 around Windows filenames.
11628
11629 @example
11630 > echo \a
11631
11632 > echo @{\a@}
11633 \a
11634 > echo "\a"
11635
11636 >
11637 @end example
11638
11639
11640 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11641
11642 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11643 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11644 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11645
11646 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11647 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11648 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11649
11650 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11651 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11652 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11653
11654 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11655
11656 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11657 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11658 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11659 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11660
11661 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11662 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11663 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11664
11665 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11666 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11667
11668 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11669 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11670 memory read caused data abort".
11671
11672 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11673 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11674 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11675 be done, feel free to add this here.
11676
11677 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11678 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11679 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11680 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11681 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11682 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11683 gracefully stops.
11684
11685 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11686 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11687 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11688
11689 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11690 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11691 bytes. Painful...
11692
11693
11694 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11695 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11696
11697 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11698 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11699 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11700 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11701 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11702 reset, everything else should work fine.
11703
11704 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11705 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11706 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11707 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11708
11709 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11710 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11711 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11712 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11713
11714 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11715
11716 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11717 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11718 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11719
11720 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11721 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11722
11723 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11724 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11725 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11726 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11727 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11728 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11729 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11730 clock frequency?
11731
11732 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11733 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11734 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11735 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11736 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11737
11738 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11739
11740 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11741 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11742 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11743 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11744 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11745 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11746 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11747
11748 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11749
11750 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11751 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11752 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11753 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11754
11755 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11756 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11757 particular order?
11758
11759 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11760 the same order used by the hardware.
11761
11762 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11763 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11764 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11765 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11766 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11767 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11768
11769 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11770 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11771 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11772 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11773
11774 @itemize @bullet
11775 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11776 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11777 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11778 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11779 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11780 @end itemize
11781
11782 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11783
11784 @itemize @bullet
11785 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11786 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11787 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11788 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11789 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11790 @end itemize
11791
11792
11793 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11794 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11795 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11796
11797 TODO.
11798
11799 @end enumerate
11800
11801 @node Tcl Crash Course
11802 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11803 @cindex Tcl
11804
11805 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11806 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11807 how the Tcl scripts work.
11808
11809 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11810 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11811 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11812 OpenOCD.
11813
11814 @section Tcl Rule #1
11815 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11816 @enumerate
11817 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11818 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11819 @end enumerate
11820
11821 The Tcl equal is this:
11822
11823 @enumerate
11824 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11825 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11826 @end enumerate
11827
11828 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11829 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11830
11831 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11832 There is a second pair of rules.
11833 @enumerate
11834 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11835 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11836 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11837 in Tcl.
11838 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11839 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11840 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11841 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11842 @end enumerate
11843
11844 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11845 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11846 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11847 Everything is a string}
11848
11849 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11850 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11851 difference is subtle.
11852 @enumerate
11853 @item Parse Time
11854 @item Evaluation Time
11855 @end enumerate
11856
11857 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11858 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11859 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11860
11861 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11862 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11863 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11864 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11865
11866 @itemize @bullet
11867 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11868 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11869 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11870 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11871 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11872 @example
11873 # bash example
11874 X=`date`
11875 echo "The Date is: $X"
11876 # Tcl example
11877 set X [date]
11878 puts "The Date is: $X"
11879 @end example
11880 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11881 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11882 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11883 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11884 is a string}
11885 @example
11886 set x "Dinner"
11887 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11888 @end example
11889 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11890 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11891 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11892 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11893 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11894 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11895 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11896 @end itemize
11897
11898 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11899
11900 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11901
11902 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11903
11904 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11905 the normal way.
11906
11907 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11908 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11909 line is immediately executed.
11910
11911 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11912 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11913
11914 @subsection Command Execution
11915
11916 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11917 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11918 control flow operators.
11919
11920 Commands are executed like this:
11921
11922 @enumerate
11923 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11924 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11925 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11926 @end enumerate
11927
11928 It sort of works like this:
11929 @example
11930 for(;;)@{
11931 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11932
11933 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11934
11935 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11936 @}
11937 @end example
11938
11939 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11940 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11941 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11942 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11943 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11944 ``LookupCommand()''
11945
11946 @subsection The FOR command
11947
11948 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11949 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11950 command just like any other command.
11951
11952 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11953 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11954 are:
11955
11956 @enumerate 0
11957 @item The ascii text 'for'
11958 @item The start text
11959 @item The test expression
11960 @item The next text
11961 @item The body text
11962 @end enumerate
11963
11964 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11965 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11966 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11967 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11968
11969 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11970 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11971
11972 @example
11973 int
11974 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11975 int *argc,
11976 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11977 @end example
11978
11979 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11980 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11981 still operates in the same basic way.
11982
11983 @subsection FOR command implementation
11984
11985 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11986 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11987
11988 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11989
11990 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11991
11992 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11993 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11994 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11995
11996 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11997 expression and returns a value.
11998
11999 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
12000 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
12001 @example
12002 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
12003
12004 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
12005
12006 int
12007 MyForCommand( void *interp,
12008 int argc,
12009 char **argv )
12010 @{
12011 if( argc != 5 )@{
12012 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
12013 return ERROR;
12014 @}
12015
12016 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
12017
12018 // Execute the start statement.
12019 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
12020
12021 // Top of loop test
12022 for(;;)@{
12023 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
12024 if( i == 0 )
12025 break;
12026
12027 // Execute the body
12028 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
12029
12030 // Execute the LOOP part
12031 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
12032 @}
12033
12034 // Return no error
12035 SetResult( interp, "" );
12036 return SUCCESS;
12037 @}
12038 @end example
12039
12040 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
12041 in the same basic way.
12042
12043 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
12044
12045 @subsection source and find commands
12046 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
12047 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
12048 @*Remember the parsing rules
12049 @enumerate
12050 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
12051 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
12052 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
12053 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
12054 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
12055 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
12056 That character begins Tcl comments.)
12057 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
12058 it reads a file and executes as a script.
12059 @end enumerate
12060 @subsection format command
12061 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
12062 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
12063 @b{sprintf()}.
12064 @b{Example}
12065 @example
12066 set x 6
12067 set y 7
12068 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
12069 @end example
12070 @enumerate
12071 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
12072 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
12073 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
12074 @* Refer to Rule #1
12075 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
12076 @* Refer to Rule #1.
12077 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
12078 @end enumerate
12079 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
12080 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
12081 @example
12082 #1 Good
12083 proc someproc @{@} @{
12084 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
12085 @}
12086 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
12087 #2 Good - no variables
12088 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
12089 #3 Good Curly Braces
12090 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
12091 puts "Time: [date]"
12092 @}
12093 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
12094 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
12095 @end example
12096 @enumerate
12097 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
12098 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
12099 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
12100 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
12101 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
12102 command.
12103 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12104 @*There are 4 examples:
12105 @enumerate
12106 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12107 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12108 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12109 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12110 @end enumerate
12111
12112 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12113 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12114 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12115
12116 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12117 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12118 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12119 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12120 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12121 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12122 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12123 @end enumerate
12124 @subsection Global Variables
12125 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12126 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12127 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12128 @example
12129 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12130 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12131 global x #Global variable X
12132 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12133 @}
12134 @end example
12135 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12136 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12137 @example
12138 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12139 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12140 # Create var name
12141 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12142 # Make it a global
12143 global $vn
12144 # Set it.
12145 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12146 @}
12147 @end example
12148 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12149 @example
12150 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12151 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12152 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12153 @}
12154 @end example
12155
12156 @node License
12157 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12158 @include fdl.texi
12159
12160 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12161 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12162 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12163 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12164 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12165 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12166
12167 @printindex cp
12168
12169 @node Command and Driver Index
12170 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12171 @printindex fn
12172
12173 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)